QEMU QMP reference 1 API Reference 1.1 Introduction 1.2 Stability Considerations 1.3 Common data types 1.4 Socket data types 1.5 VM run state 1.6 Cryptography 1.7 Block devices 1.7.1 Block core (VM unrelated) 1.7.2 Background jobs 1.7.3 Additional block stuff (VM related) 1.8 Character devices 1.9 Dump guest memory 1.10 Net devices 1.11 RDMA device 1.12 Rocker switch device 1.13 TPM (trusted platform module) devices 1.14 Remote desktop 1.14.1 Spice 1.14.2 VNC 1.15 Input 1.16 Migration 1.17 Transactions 1.18 Tracing 1.19 QMP introspection 1.20 QEMU Object Model (QOM) 1.21 Device infrastructure (qdev) 1.22 Machines 1.23 Miscellanea Commands and Events Index Data Types Index QEMU QMP reference ****************** 1 API Reference *************** 1.1 Introduction ================ This document describes all commands currently supported by QMP. Most of the time their usage is exactly the same as in the user Monitor, this means that any other document which also describe commands (the manpage, QEMU's manual, etc) can and should be consulted. QMP has two types of commands: regular and query commands. Regular commands usually change the Virtual Machine's state someway, while query commands just return information. The sections below are divided accordingly. It's important to observe that all communication examples are formatted in a reader-friendly way, so that they're easier to understand. However, in real protocol usage, they're emitted as a single line. Also, the following notation is used to denote data flow: Example: -> data issued by the Client <- Server data response Please, refer to the QMP specification (docs/interop/qmp-spec.txt) for detailed information on the Server command and response formats. 1.2 Stability Considerations ============================ The current QMP command set (described in this file) may be useful for a number of use cases, however it's limited and several commands have bad defined semantics, specially with regard to command completion. These problems are going to be solved incrementally in the next QEMU releases and we're going to establish a deprecation policy for badly defined commands. If you're planning to adopt QMP, please observe the following: 1. The deprecation policy will take effect and be documented soon, please check the documentation of each used command as soon as a new release of QEMU is available 2. DO NOT rely on anything which is not explicit documented 3. Errors, in special, are not documented. Applications should NOT check for specific errors classes or data (it's strongly recommended to only check for the "error" key) 1.3 Common data types ===================== -- Enum: QapiErrorClass QEMU error classes Values: 'GenericError' this is used for errors that don't require a specific error class. This should be the default case for most errors 'CommandNotFound' the requested command has not been found 'DeviceNotActive' a device has failed to be become active 'DeviceNotFound' the requested device has not been found 'KVMMissingCap' the requested operation can't be fulfilled because a required KVM capability is missing Since: 1.2 -- Enum: IoOperationType An enumeration of the I/O operation types Values: 'read' read operation 'write' write operation Since: 2.1 -- Enum: OnOffAuto An enumeration of three options: on, off, and auto Values: 'auto' QEMU selects the value between on and off 'on' Enabled 'off' Disabled Since: 2.2 -- Enum: OnOffSplit An enumeration of three values: on, off, and split Values: 'on' Enabled 'off' Disabled 'split' Mixed Since: 2.6 -- Object: String A fat type wrapping 'str', to be embedded in lists. Members: 'str: string' Not documented Since: 1.2 -- Alternate: StrOrNull This is a string value or the explicit lack of a string (null pointer in C). Intended for cases when 'optional absent' already has a different meaning. Members: 's: string' the string value 'n: null' no string value Since: 2.10 -- Enum: OffAutoPCIBAR An enumeration of options for specifying a PCI BAR Values: 'off' The specified feature is disabled 'auto' The PCI BAR for the feature is automatically selected 'bar0' PCI BAR0 is used for the feature 'bar1' PCI BAR1 is used for the feature 'bar2' PCI BAR2 is used for the feature 'bar3' PCI BAR3 is used for the feature 'bar4' PCI BAR4 is used for the feature 'bar5' PCI BAR5 is used for the feature Since: 2.12 -- Enum: PCIELinkSpeed An enumeration of PCIe link speeds in units of GT/s Values: '2_5' 2.5GT/s '5' 5.0GT/s '8' 8.0GT/s '16' 16.0GT/s Since: 4.0 -- Enum: PCIELinkWidth An enumeration of PCIe link width Values: '1' x1 '2' x2 '4' x4 '8' x8 '12' x12 '16' x16 '32' x32 Since: 4.0 -- Enum: SysEmuTarget The comprehensive enumeration of QEMU system emulation ("softmmu") targets. Run "./configure -help" in the project root directory, and look for the *-softmmu targets near the "-target-list" option. The individual target constants are not documented here, for the time being. Values: 'aarch64' Not documented 'alpha' Not documented 'arm' Not documented 'cris' Not documented 'hppa' Not documented 'i386' Not documented 'lm32' Not documented 'm68k' Not documented 'microblaze' Not documented 'microblazeel' Not documented 'mips' Not documented 'mips64' Not documented 'mips64el' Not documented 'mipsel' Not documented 'moxie' Not documented 'nios2' Not documented 'or1k' Not documented 'ppc' Not documented 'ppc64' Not documented 'riscv32' Not documented 'riscv64' Not documented 's390x' Not documented 'sh4' Not documented 'sh4eb' Not documented 'sparc' Not documented 'sparc64' Not documented 'tricore' Not documented 'unicore32' Not documented 'x86_64' Not documented 'xtensa' Not documented 'xtensaeb' Not documented Notes: The resulting QMP strings can be appended to the "qemu-system-" prefix to produce the corresponding QEMU executable name. This is true even for "qemu-system-x86_64". ppcemb: dropped in 3.1 Since: 3.0 1.4 Socket data types ===================== -- Enum: NetworkAddressFamily The network address family Values: 'ipv4' IPV4 family 'ipv6' IPV6 family 'unix' unix socket 'vsock' vsock family (since 2.8) 'unknown' otherwise Since: 2.1 -- Object: InetSocketAddressBase Members: 'host: string' host part of the address 'port: string' port part of the address -- Object: InetSocketAddress Captures a socket address or address range in the Internet namespace. Members: 'numeric: boolean' (optional) true if the host/port are guaranteed to be numeric, false if name resolution should be attempted. Defaults to false. (Since 2.9) 'to: int' (optional) If present, this is range of possible addresses, with port between 'port' and 'to'. 'ipv4: boolean' (optional) whether to accept IPv4 addresses, default try both IPv4 and IPv6 'ipv6: boolean' (optional) whether to accept IPv6 addresses, default try both IPv4 and IPv6 The members of 'InetSocketAddressBase' Since: 1.3 -- Object: UnixSocketAddress Captures a socket address in the local ("Unix socket") namespace. Members: 'path: string' filesystem path to use Since: 1.3 -- Object: VsockSocketAddress Captures a socket address in the vsock namespace. Members: 'cid: string' unique host identifier 'port: string' port Note: string types are used to allow for possible future hostname or service resolution support. Since: 2.8 -- Object: SocketAddressLegacy Captures the address of a socket, which could also be a named file descriptor Members: 'type' One of "inet", "unix", "vsock", "fd" 'data: InetSocketAddress' when 'type' is "inet" 'data: UnixSocketAddress' when 'type' is "unix" 'data: VsockSocketAddress' when 'type' is "vsock" 'data: String' when 'type' is "fd" Note: This type is deprecated in favor of SocketAddress. The difference between SocketAddressLegacy and SocketAddress is that the latter is a flat union rather than a simple union. Flat is nicer because it avoids nesting on the wire, i.e. that form has fewer {}. Since: 1.3 -- Enum: SocketAddressType Available SocketAddress types Values: 'inet' Internet address 'unix' Unix domain socket 'vsock' VMCI address 'fd' decimal is for file descriptor number, otherwise a file descriptor name. Named file descriptors are permitted in monitor commands, in combination with the 'getfd' command. Decimal file descriptors are permitted at startup or other contexts where no monitor context is active. Since: 2.9 -- Object: SocketAddress Captures the address of a socket, which could also be a named file descriptor Members: 'type: SocketAddressType' Transport type The members of 'InetSocketAddress' when 'type' is "inet" The members of 'UnixSocketAddress' when 'type' is "unix" The members of 'VsockSocketAddress' when 'type' is "vsock" The members of 'String' when 'type' is "fd" Since: 2.9 1.5 VM run state ================ -- Enum: RunState An enumeration of VM run states. Values: 'debug' QEMU is running on a debugger 'finish-migrate' guest is paused to finish the migration process 'inmigrate' guest is paused waiting for an incoming migration. Note that this state does not tell whether the machine will start at the end of the migration. This depends on the command-line -S option and any invocation of 'stop' or 'cont' that has happened since QEMU was started. 'internal-error' An internal error that prevents further guest execution has occurred 'io-error' the last IOP has failed and the device is configured to pause on I/O errors 'paused' guest has been paused via the 'stop' command 'postmigrate' guest is paused following a successful 'migrate' 'prelaunch' QEMU was started with -S and guest has not started 'restore-vm' guest is paused to restore VM state 'running' guest is actively running 'save-vm' guest is paused to save the VM state 'shutdown' guest is shut down (and -no-shutdown is in use) 'suspended' guest is suspended (ACPI S3) 'watchdog' the watchdog action is configured to pause and has been triggered 'guest-panicked' guest has been panicked as a result of guest OS panic 'colo' guest is paused to save/restore VM state under colo checkpoint, VM can not get into this state unless colo capability is enabled for migration. (since 2.8) 'preconfig' QEMU is paused before board specific init callback is executed. The state is reachable only if the -preconfig CLI option is used. (Since 3.0) -- Enum: ShutdownCause An enumeration of reasons for a Shutdown. Values: 'none' No shutdown request pending 'host-error' An error prevents further use of guest 'host-qmp-quit' Reaction to the QMP command 'quit' 'host-qmp-system-reset' Reaction to the QMP command 'system_reset' 'host-signal' Reaction to a signal, such as SIGINT 'host-ui' Reaction to a UI event, like window close 'guest-shutdown' Guest shutdown/suspend request, via ACPI or other hardware-specific means 'guest-reset' Guest reset request, and command line turns that into a shutdown 'guest-panic' Guest panicked, and command line turns that into a shutdown 'subsystem-reset' Partial guest reset that does not trigger QMP events and ignores -no-reboot. This is useful for sanitizing hypercalls on s390 that are used during kexec/kdump/boot -- Object: StatusInfo Information about VCPU run state Members: 'running: boolean' true if all VCPUs are runnable, false if not runnable 'singlestep: boolean' true if VCPUs are in single-step mode 'status: RunState' the virtual machine 'RunState' Since: 0.14.0 Notes: 'singlestep' is enabled through the GDB stub -- Command: query-status Query the run status of all VCPUs Returns: 'StatusInfo' reflecting all VCPUs Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-status" } <- { "return": { "running": true, "singlestep": false, "status": "running" } } -- Event: SHUTDOWN Emitted when the virtual machine has shut down, indicating that qemu is about to exit. Arguments: 'guest: boolean' If true, the shutdown was triggered by a guest request (such as a guest-initiated ACPI shutdown request or other hardware-specific action) rather than a host request (such as sending qemu a SIGINT). (since 2.10) 'reason: ShutdownCause' The 'ShutdownCause' which resulted in the SHUTDOWN. (since 4.0) Note: If the command-line option "-no-shutdown" has been specified, qemu will not exit, and a STOP event will eventually follow the SHUTDOWN event Since: 0.12.0 Example: <- { "event": "SHUTDOWN", "data": { "guest": true }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267040730, "microseconds": 682951 } } -- Event: POWERDOWN Emitted when the virtual machine is powered down through the power control system, such as via ACPI. Since: 0.12.0 Example: <- { "event": "POWERDOWN", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267040730, "microseconds": 682951 } } -- Event: RESET Emitted when the virtual machine is reset Arguments: 'guest: boolean' If true, the reset was triggered by a guest request (such as a guest-initiated ACPI reboot request or other hardware-specific action) rather than a host request (such as the QMP command system_reset). (since 2.10) 'reason: ShutdownCause' The 'ShutdownCause' of the RESET. (since 4.0) Since: 0.12.0 Example: <- { "event": "RESET", "data": { "guest": false }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267041653, "microseconds": 9518 } } -- Event: STOP Emitted when the virtual machine is stopped Since: 0.12.0 Example: <- { "event": "STOP", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267041730, "microseconds": 281295 } } -- Event: RESUME Emitted when the virtual machine resumes execution Since: 0.12.0 Example: <- { "event": "RESUME", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1271770767, "microseconds": 582542 } } -- Event: SUSPEND Emitted when guest enters a hardware suspension state, for example, S3 state, which is sometimes called standby state Since: 1.1 Example: <- { "event": "SUSPEND", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344456160, "microseconds": 309119 } } -- Event: SUSPEND_DISK Emitted when guest enters a hardware suspension state with data saved on disk, for example, S4 state, which is sometimes called hibernate state Note: QEMU shuts down (similar to event 'SHUTDOWN') when entering this state Since: 1.2 Example: <- { "event": "SUSPEND_DISK", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344456160, "microseconds": 309119 } } -- Event: WAKEUP Emitted when the guest has woken up from suspend state and is running Since: 1.1 Example: <- { "event": "WAKEUP", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } } -- Event: WATCHDOG Emitted when the watchdog device's timer is expired Arguments: 'action: WatchdogAction' action that has been taken Note: If action is "reset", "shutdown", or "pause" the WATCHDOG event is followed respectively by the RESET, SHUTDOWN, or STOP events Note: This event is rate-limited. Since: 0.13.0 Example: <- { "event": "WATCHDOG", "data": { "action": "reset" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } } -- Enum: WatchdogAction An enumeration of the actions taken when the watchdog device's timer is expired Values: 'reset' system resets 'shutdown' system shutdown, note that it is similar to 'powerdown', which tries to set to system status and notify guest 'poweroff' system poweroff, the emulator program exits 'pause' system pauses, similar to 'stop' 'debug' system enters debug state 'none' nothing is done 'inject-nmi' a non-maskable interrupt is injected into the first VCPU (all VCPUS on x86) (since 2.4) Since: 2.1 -- Command: watchdog-set-action Set watchdog action Arguments: 'action: WatchdogAction' Not documented Since: 2.11 -- Event: GUEST_PANICKED Emitted when guest OS panic is detected Arguments: 'action: GuestPanicAction' action that has been taken, currently always "pause" 'info: GuestPanicInformation' (optional) information about a panic (since 2.9) Since: 1.5 Example: <- { "event": "GUEST_PANICKED", "data": { "action": "pause" } } -- Enum: GuestPanicAction An enumeration of the actions taken when guest OS panic is detected Values: 'pause' system pauses 'poweroff' Not documented Since: 2.1 (poweroff since 2.8) -- Enum: GuestPanicInformationType An enumeration of the guest panic information types Values: 'hyper-v' hyper-v guest panic information type 's390' s390 guest panic information type (Since: 2.12) Since: 2.9 -- Object: GuestPanicInformation Information about a guest panic Members: 'type: GuestPanicInformationType' Crash type that defines the hypervisor specific information The members of 'GuestPanicInformationHyperV' when 'type' is "hyper-v" The members of 'GuestPanicInformationS390' when 'type' is "s390" Since: 2.9 -- Object: GuestPanicInformationHyperV Hyper-V specific guest panic information (HV crash MSRs) Members: 'arg1: int' Not documented 'arg2: int' Not documented 'arg3: int' Not documented 'arg4: int' Not documented 'arg5: int' Not documented Since: 2.9 -- Enum: S390CrashReason Reason why the CPU is in a crashed state. Values: 'unknown' no crash reason was set 'disabled-wait' the CPU has entered a disabled wait state 'extint-loop' clock comparator or cpu timer interrupt with new PSW enabled for external interrupts 'pgmint-loop' program interrupt with BAD new PSW 'opint-loop' operation exception interrupt with invalid code at the program interrupt new PSW Since: 2.12 -- Object: GuestPanicInformationS390 S390 specific guest panic information (PSW) Members: 'core: int' core id of the CPU that crashed 'psw-mask: int' control fields of guest PSW 'psw-addr: int' guest instruction address 'reason: S390CrashReason' guest crash reason Since: 2.12 1.6 Cryptography ================ -- Enum: QCryptoTLSCredsEndpoint The type of network endpoint that will be using the credentials. Most types of credential require different setup / structures depending on whether they will be used in a server versus a client. Values: 'client' the network endpoint is acting as the client 'server' the network endpoint is acting as the server Since: 2.5 -- Enum: QCryptoSecretFormat The data format that the secret is provided in Values: 'raw' raw bytes. When encoded in JSON only valid UTF-8 sequences can be used 'base64' arbitrary base64 encoded binary data Since: 2.6 -- Enum: QCryptoHashAlgorithm The supported algorithms for computing content digests Values: 'md5' MD5. Should not be used in any new code, legacy compat only 'sha1' SHA-1. Should not be used in any new code, legacy compat only 'sha224' SHA-224. (since 2.7) 'sha256' SHA-256. Current recommended strong hash. 'sha384' SHA-384. (since 2.7) 'sha512' SHA-512. (since 2.7) 'ripemd160' RIPEMD-160. (since 2.7) Since: 2.6 -- Enum: QCryptoCipherAlgorithm The supported algorithms for content encryption ciphers Values: 'aes-128' AES with 128 bit / 16 byte keys 'aes-192' AES with 192 bit / 24 byte keys 'aes-256' AES with 256 bit / 32 byte keys 'des-rfb' RFB specific variant of single DES. Do not use except in VNC. '3des' 3DES(EDE) with 192 bit / 24 byte keys (since 2.9) 'cast5-128' Cast5 with 128 bit / 16 byte keys 'serpent-128' Serpent with 128 bit / 16 byte keys 'serpent-192' Serpent with 192 bit / 24 byte keys 'serpent-256' Serpent with 256 bit / 32 byte keys 'twofish-128' Twofish with 128 bit / 16 byte keys 'twofish-192' Twofish with 192 bit / 24 byte keys 'twofish-256' Twofish with 256 bit / 32 byte keys Since: 2.6 -- Enum: QCryptoCipherMode The supported modes for content encryption ciphers Values: 'ecb' Electronic Code Book 'cbc' Cipher Block Chaining 'xts' XEX with tweaked code book and ciphertext stealing 'ctr' Counter (Since 2.8) Since: 2.6 -- Enum: QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm The supported algorithms for generating initialization vectors for full disk encryption. The 'plain' generator should not be used for disks with sector numbers larger than 2^32, except where compatibility with pre-existing Linux dm-crypt volumes is required. Values: 'plain' 64-bit sector number truncated to 32-bits 'plain64' 64-bit sector number 'essiv' 64-bit sector number encrypted with a hash of the encryption key Since: 2.6 -- Enum: QCryptoBlockFormat The supported full disk encryption formats Values: 'qcow' QCow/QCow2 built-in AES-CBC encryption. Use only for liberating data from old images. 'luks' LUKS encryption format. Recommended for new images Since: 2.6 -- Object: QCryptoBlockOptionsBase The common options that apply to all full disk encryption formats Members: 'format: QCryptoBlockFormat' the encryption format Since: 2.6 -- Object: QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow The options that apply to QCow/QCow2 AES-CBC encryption format Members: 'key-secret: string' (optional) the ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the decryption key. Mandatory except when probing image for metadata only. Since: 2.6 -- Object: QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS The options that apply to LUKS encryption format Members: 'key-secret: string' (optional) the ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the decryption key. Mandatory except when probing image for metadata only. Since: 2.6 -- Object: QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS The options that apply to LUKS encryption format initialization Members: 'cipher-alg: QCryptoCipherAlgorithm' (optional) the cipher algorithm for data encryption Currently defaults to 'aes-256'. 'cipher-mode: QCryptoCipherMode' (optional) the cipher mode for data encryption Currently defaults to 'xts' 'ivgen-alg: QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm' (optional) the initialization vector generator Currently defaults to 'plain64' 'ivgen-hash-alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm' (optional) the initialization vector generator hash Currently defaults to 'sha256' 'hash-alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm' (optional) the master key hash algorithm Currently defaults to 'sha256' 'iter-time: int' (optional) number of milliseconds to spend in PBKDF passphrase processing. Currently defaults to 2000. (since 2.8) The members of 'QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS' Since: 2.6 -- Object: QCryptoBlockOpenOptions The options that are available for all encryption formats when opening an existing volume Members: The members of 'QCryptoBlockOptionsBase' The members of 'QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow' when 'format' is "qcow" The members of 'QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS' when 'format' is "luks" Since: 2.6 -- Object: QCryptoBlockCreateOptions The options that are available for all encryption formats when initializing a new volume Members: The members of 'QCryptoBlockOptionsBase' The members of 'QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow' when 'format' is "qcow" The members of 'QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS' when 'format' is "luks" Since: 2.6 -- Object: QCryptoBlockInfoBase The common information that applies to all full disk encryption formats Members: 'format: QCryptoBlockFormat' the encryption format Since: 2.7 -- Object: QCryptoBlockInfoLUKSSlot Information about the LUKS block encryption key slot options Members: 'active: boolean' whether the key slot is currently in use 'key-offset: int' offset to the key material in bytes 'iters: int' (optional) number of PBKDF2 iterations for key material 'stripes: int' (optional) number of stripes for splitting key material Since: 2.7 -- Object: QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS Information about the LUKS block encryption options Members: 'cipher-alg: QCryptoCipherAlgorithm' the cipher algorithm for data encryption 'cipher-mode: QCryptoCipherMode' the cipher mode for data encryption 'ivgen-alg: QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm' the initialization vector generator 'ivgen-hash-alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm' (optional) the initialization vector generator hash 'hash-alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm' the master key hash algorithm 'payload-offset: int' offset to the payload data in bytes 'master-key-iters: int' number of PBKDF2 iterations for key material 'uuid: string' unique identifier for the volume 'slots: array of QCryptoBlockInfoLUKSSlot' information about each key slot Since: 2.7 -- Object: QCryptoBlockInfo Information about the block encryption options Members: The members of 'QCryptoBlockInfoBase' The members of 'QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS' when 'format' is "luks" Since: 2.7 1.7 Block devices ================= 1.7.1 Block core (VM unrelated) ------------------------------- 1.7.2 Background jobs --------------------- -- Enum: JobType Type of a background job. Values: 'commit' block commit job type, see "block-commit" 'stream' block stream job type, see "block-stream" 'mirror' drive mirror job type, see "drive-mirror" 'backup' drive backup job type, see "drive-backup" 'create' image creation job type, see "blockdev-create" (since 3.0) Since: 1.7 -- Enum: JobStatus Indicates the present state of a given job in its lifetime. Values: 'undefined' Erroneous, default state. Should not ever be visible. 'created' The job has been created, but not yet started. 'running' The job is currently running. 'paused' The job is running, but paused. The pause may be requested by either the QMP user or by internal processes. 'ready' The job is running, but is ready for the user to signal completion. This is used for long-running jobs like mirror that are designed to run indefinitely. 'standby' The job is ready, but paused. This is nearly identical to 'paused'. The job may return to 'ready' or otherwise be canceled. 'waiting' The job is waiting for other jobs in the transaction to converge to the waiting state. This status will likely not be visible for the last job in a transaction. 'pending' The job has finished its work, but has finalization steps that it needs to make prior to completing. These changes will require manual intervention via 'job-finalize' if auto-finalize was set to false. These pending changes may still fail. 'aborting' The job is in the process of being aborted, and will finish with an error. The job will afterwards report that it is 'concluded'. This status may not be visible to the management process. 'concluded' The job has finished all work. If auto-dismiss was set to false, the job will remain in the query list until it is dismissed via 'job-dismiss'. 'null' The job is in the process of being dismantled. This state should not ever be visible externally. Since: 2.12 -- Enum: JobVerb Represents command verbs that can be applied to a job. Values: 'cancel' see 'job-cancel' 'pause' see 'job-pause' 'resume' see 'job-resume' 'set-speed' see 'block-job-set-speed' 'complete' see 'job-complete' 'dismiss' see 'job-dismiss' 'finalize' see 'job-finalize' Since: 2.12 -- Event: JOB_STATUS_CHANGE Emitted when a job transitions to a different status. Arguments: 'id: string' The job identifier 'status: JobStatus' The new job status Since: 3.0 -- Command: job-pause Pause an active job. This command returns immediately after marking the active job for pausing. Pausing an already paused job is an error. The job will pause as soon as possible, which means transitioning into the PAUSED state if it was RUNNING, or into STANDBY if it was READY. The corresponding JOB_STATUS_CHANGE event will be emitted. Cancelling a paused job automatically resumes it. Arguments: 'id: string' The job identifier. Since: 3.0 -- Command: job-resume Resume a paused job. This command returns immediately after resuming a paused job. Resuming an already running job is an error. 'id' : The job identifier. Arguments: 'id: string' Not documented Since: 3.0 -- Command: job-cancel Instruct an active background job to cancel at the next opportunity. This command returns immediately after marking the active job for cancellation. The job will cancel as soon as possible and then emit a JOB_STATUS_CHANGE event. Usually, the status will change to ABORTING, but it is possible that a job successfully completes (e.g. because it was almost done and there was no opportunity to cancel earlier than completing the job) and transitions to PENDING instead. Arguments: 'id: string' The job identifier. Since: 3.0 -- Command: job-complete Manually trigger completion of an active job in the READY state. Arguments: 'id: string' The job identifier. Since: 3.0 -- Command: job-dismiss Deletes a job that is in the CONCLUDED state. This command only needs to be run explicitly for jobs that don't have automatic dismiss enabled. This command will refuse to operate on any job that has not yet reached its terminal state, JOB_STATUS_CONCLUDED. For jobs that make use of JOB_READY event, job-cancel or job-complete will still need to be used as appropriate. Arguments: 'id: string' The job identifier. Since: 3.0 -- Command: job-finalize Instructs all jobs in a transaction (or a single job if it is not part of any transaction) to finalize any graph changes and do any necessary cleanup. This command requires that all involved jobs are in the PENDING state. For jobs in a transaction, instructing one job to finalize will force ALL jobs in the transaction to finalize, so it is only necessary to instruct a single member job to finalize. Arguments: 'id: string' The identifier of any job in the transaction, or of a job that is not part of any transaction. Since: 3.0 -- Object: JobInfo Information about a job. Members: 'id: string' The job identifier 'type: JobType' The kind of job that is being performed 'status: JobStatus' Current job state/status 'current-progress: int' Progress made until now. The unit is arbitrary and the value can only meaningfully be used for the ratio of 'current-progress' to 'total-progress'. The value is monotonically increasing. 'total-progress: int' Estimated 'current-progress' value at the completion of the job. This value can arbitrarily change while the job is running, in both directions. 'error: string' (optional) If this field is present, the job failed; if it is still missing in the CONCLUDED state, this indicates successful completion. The value is a human-readable error message to describe the reason for the job failure. It should not be parsed by applications. Since: 3.0 -- Command: query-jobs Return information about jobs. Returns: a list with a 'JobInfo' for each active job Since: 3.0 -- Object: SnapshotInfo Members: 'id: string' unique snapshot id 'name: string' user chosen name 'vm-state-size: int' size of the VM state 'date-sec: int' UTC date of the snapshot in seconds 'date-nsec: int' fractional part in nano seconds to be used with date-sec 'vm-clock-sec: int' VM clock relative to boot in seconds 'vm-clock-nsec: int' fractional part in nano seconds to be used with vm-clock-sec Since: 1.3 -- Object: ImageInfoSpecificQCow2EncryptionBase Members: 'format: BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat' The encryption format Since: 2.10 -- Object: ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Encryption Members: The members of 'ImageInfoSpecificQCow2EncryptionBase' The members of 'QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS' when 'format' is "luks" Since: 2.10 -- Object: ImageInfoSpecificQCow2 Members: 'compat: string' compatibility level 'data-file: string' (optional) the filename of the external data file that is stored in the image and used as a default for opening the image (since: 4.0) 'data-file-raw: boolean' (optional) True if the external data file must stay valid as a standalone (read-only) raw image without looking at qcow2 metadata (since: 4.0) 'lazy-refcounts: boolean' (optional) on or off; only valid for compat >= 1.1 'corrupt: boolean' (optional) true if the image has been marked corrupt; only valid for compat >= 1.1 (since 2.2) 'refcount-bits: int' width of a refcount entry in bits (since 2.3) 'encrypt: ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Encryption' (optional) details about encryption parameters; only set if image is encrypted (since 2.10) 'bitmaps: array of Qcow2BitmapInfo' (optional) A list of qcow2 bitmap details (since 4.0) Since: 1.7 -- Object: ImageInfoSpecificVmdk Members: 'create-type: string' The create type of VMDK image 'cid: int' Content id of image 'parent-cid: int' Parent VMDK image's cid 'extents: array of ImageInfo' List of extent files Since: 1.7 -- Object: ImageInfoSpecific A discriminated record of image format specific information structures. Members: 'type' One of "qcow2", "vmdk", "luks" 'data: ImageInfoSpecificQCow2' when 'type' is "qcow2" 'data: ImageInfoSpecificVmdk' when 'type' is "vmdk" 'data: QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS' when 'type' is "luks" Since: 1.7 -- Object: ImageInfo Information about a QEMU image file Members: 'filename: string' name of the image file 'format: string' format of the image file 'virtual-size: int' maximum capacity in bytes of the image 'actual-size: int' (optional) actual size on disk in bytes of the image 'dirty-flag: boolean' (optional) true if image is not cleanly closed 'cluster-size: int' (optional) size of a cluster in bytes 'encrypted: boolean' (optional) true if the image is encrypted 'compressed: boolean' (optional) true if the image is compressed (Since 1.7) 'backing-filename: string' (optional) name of the backing file 'full-backing-filename: string' (optional) full path of the backing file 'backing-filename-format: string' (optional) the format of the backing file 'snapshots: array of SnapshotInfo' (optional) list of VM snapshots 'backing-image: ImageInfo' (optional) info of the backing image (since 1.6) 'format-specific: ImageInfoSpecific' (optional) structure supplying additional format-specific information (since 1.7) Since: 1.3 -- Object: ImageCheck Information about a QEMU image file check Members: 'filename: string' name of the image file checked 'format: string' format of the image file checked 'check-errors: int' number of unexpected errors occurred during check 'image-end-offset: int' (optional) offset (in bytes) where the image ends, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it 'corruptions: int' (optional) number of corruptions found during the check if any 'leaks: int' (optional) number of leaks found during the check if any 'corruptions-fixed: int' (optional) number of corruptions fixed during the check if any 'leaks-fixed: int' (optional) number of leaks fixed during the check if any 'total-clusters: int' (optional) total number of clusters, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it 'allocated-clusters: int' (optional) total number of allocated clusters, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it 'fragmented-clusters: int' (optional) total number of fragmented clusters, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it 'compressed-clusters: int' (optional) total number of compressed clusters, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it Since: 1.4 -- Object: MapEntry Mapping information from a virtual block range to a host file range Members: 'start: int' the start byte of the mapped virtual range 'length: int' the number of bytes of the mapped virtual range 'data: boolean' whether the mapped range has data 'zero: boolean' whether the virtual blocks are zeroed 'depth: int' the depth of the mapping 'offset: int' (optional) the offset in file that the virtual sectors are mapped to 'filename: string' (optional) filename that is referred to by 'offset' Since: 2.6 -- Object: BlockdevCacheInfo Cache mode information for a block device Members: 'writeback: boolean' true if writeback mode is enabled 'direct: boolean' true if the host page cache is bypassed (O_DIRECT) 'no-flush: boolean' true if flush requests are ignored for the device Since: 2.3 -- Object: BlockDeviceInfo Information about the backing device for a block device. Members: 'file: string' the filename of the backing device 'node-name: string' (optional) the name of the block driver node (Since 2.0) 'ro: boolean' true if the backing device was open read-only 'drv: string' the name of the block format used to open the backing device. As of 0.14.0 this can be: 'blkdebug', 'bochs', 'cloop', 'cow', 'dmg', 'file', 'file', 'ftp', 'ftps', 'host_cdrom', 'host_device', 'http', 'https', 'luks', 'nbd', 'parallels', 'qcow', 'qcow2', 'raw', 'vdi', 'vmdk', 'vpc', 'vvfat' 2.2: 'archipelago' added, 'cow' dropped 2.3: 'host_floppy' deprecated 2.5: 'host_floppy' dropped 2.6: 'luks' added 2.8: 'replication' added, 'tftp' dropped 2.9: 'archipelago' dropped 'backing_file: string' (optional) the name of the backing file (for copy-on-write) 'backing_file_depth: int' number of files in the backing file chain (since: 1.2) 'encrypted: boolean' true if the backing device is encrypted 'encryption_key_missing: boolean' Deprecated; always false 'detect_zeroes: BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions' detect and optimize zero writes (Since 2.1) 'bps: int' total throughput limit in bytes per second is specified 'bps_rd: int' read throughput limit in bytes per second is specified 'bps_wr: int' write throughput limit in bytes per second is specified 'iops: int' total I/O operations per second is specified 'iops_rd: int' read I/O operations per second is specified 'iops_wr: int' write I/O operations per second is specified 'image: ImageInfo' the info of image used (since: 1.6) 'bps_max: int' (optional) total throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) 'bps_rd_max: int' (optional) read throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) 'bps_wr_max: int' (optional) write throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) 'iops_max: int' (optional) total I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) 'iops_rd_max: int' (optional) read I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) 'iops_wr_max: int' (optional) write I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) 'bps_max_length: int' (optional) maximum length of the 'bps_max' burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6) 'bps_rd_max_length: int' (optional) maximum length of the 'bps_rd_max' burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6) 'bps_wr_max_length: int' (optional) maximum length of the 'bps_wr_max' burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6) 'iops_max_length: int' (optional) maximum length of the 'iops' burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6) 'iops_rd_max_length: int' (optional) maximum length of the 'iops_rd_max' burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6) 'iops_wr_max_length: int' (optional) maximum length of the 'iops_wr_max' burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6) 'iops_size: int' (optional) an I/O size in bytes (Since 1.7) 'group: string' (optional) throttle group name (Since 2.4) 'cache: BlockdevCacheInfo' the cache mode used for the block device (since: 2.3) 'write_threshold: int' configured write threshold for the device. 0 if disabled. (Since 2.3) Since: 0.14.0 -- Enum: BlockDeviceIoStatus An enumeration of block device I/O status. Values: 'ok' The last I/O operation has succeeded 'failed' The last I/O operation has failed 'nospace' The last I/O operation has failed due to a no-space condition Since: 1.0 -- Object: BlockDeviceMapEntry Entry in the metadata map of the device (returned by "qemu-img map") Members: 'start: int' Offset in the image of the first byte described by this entry (in bytes) 'length: int' Length of the range described by this entry (in bytes) 'depth: int' Number of layers (0 = top image, 1 = top image's backing file, etc.) before reaching one for which the range is allocated. The value is in the range 0 to the depth of the image chain - 1. 'zero: boolean' the sectors in this range read as zeros 'data: boolean' reading the image will actually read data from a file (in particular, if 'offset' is present this means that the sectors are not simply preallocated, but contain actual data in raw format) 'offset: int' (optional) if present, the image file stores the data for this range in raw format at the given offset. Since: 1.7 -- Enum: DirtyBitmapStatus An enumeration of possible states that a dirty bitmap can report to the user. Values: 'frozen' The bitmap is currently in-use by some operation and is immutable. If the bitmap was 'active' prior to the operation, new writes by the guest are being recorded in a temporary buffer, and will not be lost. Generally, bitmaps are cleared on successful use in an operation and the temporary buffer is committed into the bitmap. On failure, the temporary buffer is merged back into the bitmap without first clearing it. Please refer to the documentation for each bitmap-using operation, See also 'blockdev-backup', 'drive-backup'. 'disabled' The bitmap is not currently recording new writes by the guest. This is requested explicitly via 'block-dirty-bitmap-disable'. It can still be cleared, deleted, or used for backup operations. 'active' The bitmap is actively monitoring for new writes, and can be cleared, deleted, or used for backup operations. 'locked' The bitmap is currently in-use by some operation and is immutable. If the bitmap was 'active' prior to the operation, it is still recording new writes. If the bitmap was 'disabled', it is not recording new writes. (Since 2.12) 'inconsistent' This is a persistent dirty bitmap that was marked in-use on disk, and is unusable by QEMU. It can only be deleted. Please rely on the inconsistent field in 'BlockDirtyInfo' instead, as the status field is deprecated. (Since 4.0) Since: 2.4 -- Object: BlockDirtyInfo Block dirty bitmap information. Members: 'name: string' (optional) the name of the dirty bitmap (Since 2.4) 'count: int' number of dirty bytes according to the dirty bitmap 'granularity: int' granularity of the dirty bitmap in bytes (since 1.4) 'status: DirtyBitmapStatus' Deprecated in favor of 'recording' and 'locked'. (since 2.4) 'recording: boolean' true if the bitmap is recording new writes from the guest. Replaces 'active' and 'disabled' statuses. (since 4.0) 'busy: boolean' true if the bitmap is in-use by some operation (NBD or jobs) and cannot be modified via QMP or used by another operation. Replaces 'locked' and 'frozen' statuses. (since 4.0) 'persistent: boolean' true if the bitmap was stored on disk, is scheduled to be stored on disk, or both. (since 4.0) 'inconsistent: boolean' (optional) true if this is a persistent bitmap that was improperly stored. Implies 'persistent' to be true; 'recording' and 'busy' to be false. This bitmap cannot be used. To remove it, use 'block-dirty-bitmap-remove'. (Since 4.0) Since: 1.3 -- Enum: Qcow2BitmapInfoFlags An enumeration of flags that a bitmap can report to the user. Values: 'in-use' This flag is set by any process actively modifying the qcow2 file, and cleared when the updated bitmap is flushed to the qcow2 image. The presence of this flag in an offline image means that the bitmap was not saved correctly after its last usage, and may contain inconsistent data. 'auto' The bitmap must reflect all changes of the virtual disk by any application that would write to this qcow2 file. Since: 4.0 -- Object: Qcow2BitmapInfo Qcow2 bitmap information. Members: 'name: string' the name of the bitmap 'granularity: int' granularity of the bitmap in bytes 'flags: array of Qcow2BitmapInfoFlags' flags of the bitmap Since: 4.0 -- Object: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo Block latency histogram. Members: 'boundaries: array of int' list of interval boundary values in nanoseconds, all greater than zero and in ascending order. For example, the list [10, 50, 100] produces the following histogram intervals: [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf). 'bins: array of int' list of io request counts corresponding to histogram intervals. len('bins') = len('boundaries') + 1 For the example above, 'bins' may be something like [3, 1, 5, 2], and corresponding histogram looks like: 5| * 4| * 3| * * 2| * * * 1| * * * * +------------ 10 50 100 Since: 4.0 -- Command: block-latency-histogram-set Manage read, write and flush latency histograms for the device. If only 'id' parameter is specified, remove all present latency histograms for the device. Otherwise, add/reset some of (or all) latency histograms. Arguments: 'id: string' The name or QOM path of the guest device. 'boundaries: array of int' (optional) list of interval boundary values (see description in BlockLatencyHistogramInfo definition). If specified, all latency histograms are removed, and empty ones created for all io types with intervals corresponding to 'boundaries' (except for io types, for which specific boundaries are set through the following parameters). 'boundaries-read: array of int' (optional) list of interval boundary values for read latency histogram. If specified, old read latency histogram is removed, and empty one created with intervals corresponding to 'boundaries-read'. The parameter has higher priority then 'boundaries'. 'boundaries-write: array of int' (optional) list of interval boundary values for write latency histogram. 'boundaries-flush: array of int' (optional) list of interval boundary values for flush latency histogram. Returns: error if device is not found or any boundary arrays are invalid. Since: 4.0 Example: set new histograms for all io types with intervals [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf): -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set", "arguments": { "id": "drive0", "boundaries": [10, 50, 100] } } <- { "return": {} } Example: set new histogram only for write, other histograms will remain not changed (or not created): -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set", "arguments": { "id": "drive0", "boundaries-write": [10, 50, 100] } } <- { "return": {} } Example: set new histograms with the following intervals: read, flush: [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf) write: [0, 1000), [1000, 5000), [5000, +inf) -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set", "arguments": { "id": "drive0", "boundaries": [10, 50, 100], "boundaries-write": [1000, 5000] } } <- { "return": {} } Example: remove all latency histograms: -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set", "arguments": { "id": "drive0" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Object: BlockInfo Block device information. This structure describes a virtual device and the backing device associated with it. Members: 'device: string' The device name associated with the virtual device. 'qdev: string' (optional) The qdev ID, or if no ID is assigned, the QOM path of the block device. (since 2.10) 'type: string' This field is returned only for compatibility reasons, it should not be used (always returns 'unknown') 'removable: boolean' True if the device supports removable media. 'locked: boolean' True if the guest has locked this device from having its media removed 'tray_open: boolean' (optional) True if the device's tray is open (only present if it has a tray) 'dirty-bitmaps: array of BlockDirtyInfo' (optional) dirty bitmaps information (only present if the driver has one or more dirty bitmaps) (Since 2.0) 'io-status: BlockDeviceIoStatus' (optional) 'BlockDeviceIoStatus'. Only present if the device supports it and the VM is configured to stop on errors (supported device models: virtio-blk, IDE, SCSI except scsi-generic) 'inserted: BlockDeviceInfo' (optional) 'BlockDeviceInfo' describing the device if media is present Since: 0.14.0 -- Object: BlockMeasureInfo Image file size calculation information. This structure describes the size requirements for creating a new image file. The size requirements depend on the new image file format. File size always equals virtual disk size for the 'raw' format, even for sparse POSIX files. Compact formats such as 'qcow2' represent unallocated and zero regions efficiently so file size may be smaller than virtual disk size. The values are upper bounds that are guaranteed to fit the new image file. Subsequent modification, such as internal snapshot or bitmap creation, may require additional space and is not covered here. Members: 'required: int' Size required for a new image file, in bytes. 'fully-allocated: int' Image file size, in bytes, once data has been written to all sectors. Since: 2.10 -- Command: query-block Get a list of BlockInfo for all virtual block devices. Returns: a list of 'BlockInfo' describing each virtual block device. Filter nodes that were created implicitly are skipped over. Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-block" } <- { "return":[ { "io-status": "ok", "device":"ide0-hd0", "locked":false, "removable":false, "inserted":{ "ro":false, "drv":"qcow2", "encrypted":false, "file":"disks/test.qcow2", "backing_file_depth":1, "bps":1000000, "bps_rd":0, "bps_wr":0, "iops":1000000, "iops_rd":0, "iops_wr":0, "bps_max": 8000000, "bps_rd_max": 0, "bps_wr_max": 0, "iops_max": 0, "iops_rd_max": 0, "iops_wr_max": 0, "iops_size": 0, "detect_zeroes": "on", "write_threshold": 0, "image":{ "filename":"disks/test.qcow2", "format":"qcow2", "virtual-size":2048000, "backing_file":"base.qcow2", "full-backing-filename":"disks/base.qcow2", "backing-filename-format":"qcow2", "snapshots":[ { "id": "1", "name": "snapshot1", "vm-state-size": 0, "date-sec": 10000200, "date-nsec": 12, "vm-clock-sec": 206, "vm-clock-nsec": 30 } ], "backing-image":{ "filename":"disks/base.qcow2", "format":"qcow2", "virtual-size":2048000 } } }, "qdev": "ide_disk", "type":"unknown" }, { "io-status": "ok", "device":"ide1-cd0", "locked":false, "removable":true, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[23]", "tray_open": false, "type":"unknown" }, { "device":"floppy0", "locked":false, "removable":true, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[20]", "type":"unknown" }, { "device":"sd0", "locked":false, "removable":true, "type":"unknown" } ] } -- Object: BlockDeviceTimedStats Statistics of a block device during a given interval of time. Members: 'interval_length: int' Interval used for calculating the statistics, in seconds. 'min_rd_latency_ns: int' Minimum latency of read operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. 'min_wr_latency_ns: int' Minimum latency of write operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. 'min_flush_latency_ns: int' Minimum latency of flush operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. 'max_rd_latency_ns: int' Maximum latency of read operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. 'max_wr_latency_ns: int' Maximum latency of write operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. 'max_flush_latency_ns: int' Maximum latency of flush operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. 'avg_rd_latency_ns: int' Average latency of read operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. 'avg_wr_latency_ns: int' Average latency of write operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. 'avg_flush_latency_ns: int' Average latency of flush operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. 'avg_rd_queue_depth: number' Average number of pending read operations in the defined interval. 'avg_wr_queue_depth: number' Average number of pending write operations in the defined interval. Since: 2.5 -- Object: BlockDeviceStats Statistics of a virtual block device or a block backing device. Members: 'rd_bytes: int' The number of bytes read by the device. 'wr_bytes: int' The number of bytes written by the device. 'rd_operations: int' The number of read operations performed by the device. 'wr_operations: int' The number of write operations performed by the device. 'flush_operations: int' The number of cache flush operations performed by the device (since 0.15.0) 'flush_total_time_ns: int' Total time spend on cache flushes in nano-seconds (since 0.15.0). 'wr_total_time_ns: int' Total time spend on writes in nano-seconds (since 0.15.0). 'rd_total_time_ns: int' Total_time_spend on reads in nano-seconds (since 0.15.0). 'wr_highest_offset: int' The offset after the greatest byte written to the device. The intended use of this information is for growable sparse files (like qcow2) that are used on top of a physical device. 'rd_merged: int' Number of read requests that have been merged into another request (Since 2.3). 'wr_merged: int' Number of write requests that have been merged into another request (Since 2.3). 'idle_time_ns: int' (optional) Time since the last I/O operation, in nanoseconds. If the field is absent it means that there haven't been any operations yet (Since 2.5). 'failed_rd_operations: int' The number of failed read operations performed by the device (Since 2.5) 'failed_wr_operations: int' The number of failed write operations performed by the device (Since 2.5) 'failed_flush_operations: int' The number of failed flush operations performed by the device (Since 2.5) 'invalid_rd_operations: int' The number of invalid read operations performed by the device (Since 2.5) 'invalid_wr_operations: int' The number of invalid write operations performed by the device (Since 2.5) 'invalid_flush_operations: int' The number of invalid flush operations performed by the device (Since 2.5) 'account_invalid: boolean' Whether invalid operations are included in the last access statistics (Since 2.5) 'account_failed: boolean' Whether failed operations are included in the latency and last access statistics (Since 2.5) 'timed_stats: array of BlockDeviceTimedStats' Statistics specific to the set of previously defined intervals of time (Since 2.5) 'rd_latency_histogram: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo' (optional) 'BlockLatencyHistogramInfo'. (Since 4.0) 'wr_latency_histogram: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo' (optional) 'BlockLatencyHistogramInfo'. (Since 4.0) 'flush_latency_histogram: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo' (optional) 'BlockLatencyHistogramInfo'. (Since 4.0) Since: 0.14.0 -- Object: BlockStats Statistics of a virtual block device or a block backing device. Members: 'device: string' (optional) If the stats are for a virtual block device, the name corresponding to the virtual block device. 'node-name: string' (optional) The node name of the device. (Since 2.3) 'qdev: string' (optional) The qdev ID, or if no ID is assigned, the QOM path of the block device. (since 3.0) 'stats: BlockDeviceStats' A 'BlockDeviceStats' for the device. 'parent: BlockStats' (optional) This describes the file block device if it has one. Contains recursively the statistics of the underlying protocol (e.g. the host file for a qcow2 image). If there is no underlying protocol, this field is omitted 'backing: BlockStats' (optional) This describes the backing block device if it has one. (Since 2.0) Since: 0.14.0 -- Command: query-blockstats Query the 'BlockStats' for all virtual block devices. Arguments: 'query-nodes: boolean' (optional) If true, the command will query all the block nodes that have a node name, in a list which will include "parent" information, but not "backing". If false or omitted, the behavior is as before - query all the device backends, recursively including their "parent" and "backing". Filter nodes that were created implicitly are skipped over in this mode. (Since 2.3) Returns: A list of 'BlockStats' for each virtual block devices. Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-blockstats" } <- { "return":[ { "device":"ide0-hd0", "parent":{ "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":3686448128, "wr_bytes":9786368, "wr_operations":751, "rd_bytes":122567168, "rd_operations":36772 "wr_total_times_ns":313253456 "rd_total_times_ns":3465673657 "flush_total_times_ns":49653 "flush_operations":61, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "idle_time_ns":2953431879, "account_invalid":true, "account_failed":false } }, "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":2821110784, "wr_bytes":9786368, "wr_operations":692, "rd_bytes":122739200, "rd_operations":36604 "flush_operations":51, "wr_total_times_ns":313253456 "rd_total_times_ns":3465673657 "flush_total_times_ns":49653, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "idle_time_ns":2953431879, "account_invalid":true, "account_failed":false }, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[23]" }, { "device":"ide1-cd0", "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":0, "wr_bytes":0, "wr_operations":0, "rd_bytes":0, "rd_operations":0 "flush_operations":0, "wr_total_times_ns":0 "rd_total_times_ns":0 "flush_total_times_ns":0, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "account_invalid":false, "account_failed":false }, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[24]" }, { "device":"floppy0", "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":0, "wr_bytes":0, "wr_operations":0, "rd_bytes":0, "rd_operations":0 "flush_operations":0, "wr_total_times_ns":0 "rd_total_times_ns":0 "flush_total_times_ns":0, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "account_invalid":false, "account_failed":false }, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[16]" }, { "device":"sd0", "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":0, "wr_bytes":0, "wr_operations":0, "rd_bytes":0, "rd_operations":0 "flush_operations":0, "wr_total_times_ns":0 "rd_total_times_ns":0 "flush_total_times_ns":0, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "account_invalid":false, "account_failed":false } } ] } -- Enum: BlockdevOnError An enumeration of possible behaviors for errors on I/O operations. The exact meaning depends on whether the I/O was initiated by a guest or by a block job Values: 'report' for guest operations, report the error to the guest; for jobs, cancel the job 'ignore' ignore the error, only report a QMP event (BLOCK_IO_ERROR or BLOCK_JOB_ERROR) 'enospc' same as 'stop' on ENOSPC, same as 'report' otherwise. 'stop' for guest operations, stop the virtual machine; for jobs, pause the job 'auto' inherit the error handling policy of the backend (since: 2.7) Since: 1.3 -- Enum: MirrorSyncMode An enumeration of possible behaviors for the initial synchronization phase of storage mirroring. Values: 'top' copies data in the topmost image to the destination 'full' copies data from all images to the destination 'none' only copy data written from now on 'incremental' only copy data described by the dirty bitmap. Since: 2.4 Since: 1.3 -- Enum: MirrorCopyMode An enumeration whose values tell the mirror block job when to trigger writes to the target. Values: 'background' copy data in background only. 'write-blocking' when data is written to the source, write it (synchronously) to the target as well. In addition, data is copied in background just like in 'background' mode. Since: 3.0 -- Object: BlockJobInfo Information about a long-running block device operation. Members: 'type: string' the job type ('stream' for image streaming) 'device: string' The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7 'len: int' Estimated 'offset' value at the completion of the job. This value can arbitrarily change while the job is running, in both directions. 'offset: int' Progress made until now. The unit is arbitrary and the value can only meaningfully be used for the ratio of 'offset' to 'len'. The value is monotonically increasing. 'busy: boolean' false if the job is known to be in a quiescent state, with no pending I/O. Since 1.3. 'paused: boolean' whether the job is paused or, if 'busy' is true, will pause itself as soon as possible. Since 1.3. 'speed: int' the rate limit, bytes per second 'io-status: BlockDeviceIoStatus' the status of the job (since 1.3) 'ready: boolean' true if the job may be completed (since 2.2) 'status: JobStatus' Current job state/status (since 2.12) 'auto-finalize: boolean' Job will finalize itself when PENDING, moving to the CONCLUDED state. (since 2.12) 'auto-dismiss: boolean' Job will dismiss itself when CONCLUDED, moving to the NULL state and disappearing from the query list. (since 2.12) 'error: string' (optional) Error information if the job did not complete successfully. Not set if the job completed successfully. (since 2.12.1) Since: 1.1 -- Command: query-block-jobs Return information about long-running block device operations. Returns: a list of 'BlockJobInfo' for each active block job Since: 1.1 -- Command: block_passwd This command sets the password of a block device that has not been open with a password and requires one. This command is now obsolete and will always return an error since 2.10 Arguments: 'device: string' (optional) Not documented 'node-name: string' (optional) Not documented 'password: string' Not documented -- Command: block_resize Resize a block image while a guest is running. Either 'device' or 'node-name' must be set but not both. Arguments: 'device: string' (optional) the name of the device to get the image resized 'node-name: string' (optional) graph node name to get the image resized (Since 2.0) 'size: int' new image size in bytes Returns: nothing on success If 'device' is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "block_resize", "arguments": { "device": "scratch", "size": 1073741824 } } <- { "return": {} } -- Enum: NewImageMode An enumeration that tells QEMU how to set the backing file path in a new image file. Values: 'existing' QEMU should look for an existing image file. 'absolute-paths' QEMU should create a new image with absolute paths for the backing file. If there is no backing file available, the new image will not be backed either. Since: 1.1 -- Object: BlockdevSnapshotSync Either 'device' or 'node-name' must be set but not both. Members: 'device: string' (optional) the name of the device to take a snapshot of. 'node-name: string' (optional) graph node name to generate the snapshot from (Since 2.0) 'snapshot-file: string' the target of the new overlay image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, the overlay will be created in the existing file/device. Otherwise, a new file will be created. 'snapshot-node-name: string' (optional) the graph node name of the new image (Since 2.0) 'format: string' (optional) the format of the overlay image, default is 'qcow2'. 'mode: NewImageMode' (optional) whether and how QEMU should create a new image, default is 'absolute-paths'. -- Object: BlockdevSnapshot Members: 'node: string' device or node name that will have a snapshot taken. 'overlay: string' reference to the existing block device that will become the overlay of 'node', as part of taking the snapshot. It must not have a current backing file (this can be achieved by passing "backing": null to blockdev-add). Since: 2.5 -- Object: DriveBackup Members: 'job-id: string' (optional) identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7) 'device: string' the device name or node-name of a root node which should be copied. 'target: string' the target of the new image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, the existing file/device will be used as the new destination. If it does not exist, a new file will be created. 'format: string' (optional) the format of the new destination, default is to probe if 'mode' is 'existing', else the format of the source 'sync: MirrorSyncMode' what parts of the disk image should be copied to the destination (all the disk, only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, from a dirty bitmap, or only new I/O). 'mode: NewImageMode' (optional) whether and how QEMU should create a new image, default is 'absolute-paths'. 'speed: int' (optional) the maximum speed, in bytes per second 'bitmap: string' (optional) the name of dirty bitmap if sync is "incremental". Must be present if sync is "incremental", must NOT be present otherwise. (Since 2.4) 'compress: boolean' (optional) true to compress data, if the target format supports it. (default: false) (since 2.8) 'on-source-error: BlockdevOnError' (optional) the action to take on an error on the source, default 'report'. 'stop' and 'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io-status (see BlockInfo). 'on-target-error: BlockdevOnError' (optional) the action to take on an error on the target, default 'report' (no limitations, since this applies to a different block device than 'device'). 'auto-finalize: boolean' (optional) When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for 'block-job-finalize' before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 2.12) 'auto-dismiss: boolean' (optional) When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits 'block-job-dismiss'. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 2.12) Note: 'on-source-error' and 'on-target-error' only affect background I/O. If an error occurs during a guest write request, the device's rerror/werror actions will be used. Since: 1.6 -- Object: BlockdevBackup Members: 'job-id: string' (optional) identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7) 'device: string' the device name or node-name of a root node which should be copied. 'target: string' the device name or node-name of the backup target node. 'sync: MirrorSyncMode' what parts of the disk image should be copied to the destination (all the disk, only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, or only new I/O). 'speed: int' (optional) the maximum speed, in bytes per second. The default is 0, for unlimited. 'bitmap: string' (optional) the name of dirty bitmap if sync is "incremental". Must be present if sync is "incremental", must NOT be present otherwise. (Since 3.1) 'compress: boolean' (optional) true to compress data, if the target format supports it. (default: false) (since 2.8) 'on-source-error: BlockdevOnError' (optional) the action to take on an error on the source, default 'report'. 'stop' and 'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io-status (see BlockInfo). 'on-target-error: BlockdevOnError' (optional) the action to take on an error on the target, default 'report' (no limitations, since this applies to a different block device than 'device'). 'auto-finalize: boolean' (optional) When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for 'block-job-finalize' before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 2.12) 'auto-dismiss: boolean' (optional) When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits 'block-job-dismiss'. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 2.12) Note: 'on-source-error' and 'on-target-error' only affect background I/O. If an error occurs during a guest write request, the device's rerror/werror actions will be used. Since: 2.3 -- Command: blockdev-snapshot-sync Takes a synchronous snapshot of a block device. For the arguments, see the documentation of BlockdevSnapshotSync. Returns: nothing on success If 'device' is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0", "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image", "format": "qcow2" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: blockdev-snapshot Takes a snapshot of a block device. Take a snapshot, by installing 'node' as the backing image of 'overlay'. Additionally, if 'node' is associated with a block device, the block device changes to using 'overlay' as its new active image. For the arguments, see the documentation of BlockdevSnapshot. Since: 2.5 Example: -> { "execute": "blockdev-add", "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2", "node-name": "node1534", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "hd1.qcow2" }, "backing": null } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot", "arguments": { "node": "ide-hd0", "overlay": "node1534" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: change-backing-file Change the backing file in the image file metadata. This does not cause QEMU to reopen the image file to reparse the backing filename (it may, however, perform a reopen to change permissions from r/o -> r/w -> r/o, if needed). The new backing file string is written into the image file metadata, and the QEMU internal strings are updated. Arguments: 'image-node-name: string' The name of the block driver state node of the image to modify. The "device" argument is used to verify "image-node-name" is in the chain described by "device". 'device: string' The device name or node-name of the root node that owns image-node-name. 'backing-file: string' The string to write as the backing file. This string is not validated, so care should be taken when specifying the string or the image chain may not be able to be reopened again. Returns: Nothing on success If "device" does not exist or cannot be determined, DeviceNotFound Since: 2.1 -- Command: block-commit Live commit of data from overlay image nodes into backing nodes - i.e., writes data between 'top' and 'base' into 'base'. Arguments: 'job-id: string' (optional) identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7) 'device: string' the device name or node-name of a root node 'base-node: string' (optional) The node name of the backing image to write data into. If not specified, this is the deepest backing image. (since: 3.1) 'base: string' (optional) Same as 'base-node', except that it is a file name rather than a node name. This must be the exact filename string that was used to open the node; other strings, even if addressing the same file, are not accepted (deprecated, use 'base-node' instead) 'top-node: string' (optional) The node name of the backing image within the image chain which contains the topmost data to be committed down. If not specified, this is the active layer. (since: 3.1) 'top: string' (optional) Same as 'top-node', except that it is a file name rather than a node name. This must be the exact filename string that was used to open the node; other strings, even if addressing the same file, are not accepted (deprecated, use 'base-node' instead) 'backing-file: string' (optional) The backing file string to write into the overlay image of 'top'. If 'top' is the active layer, specifying a backing file string is an error. This filename is not validated. If a pathname string is such that it cannot be resolved by QEMU, that means that subsequent QMP or HMP commands must use node-names for the image in question, as filename lookup methods will fail. If not specified, QEMU will automatically determine the backing file string to use, or error out if there is no obvious choice. Care should be taken when specifying the string, to specify a valid filename or protocol. (Since 2.1) If top == base, that is an error. If top == active, the job will not be completed by itself, user needs to complete the job with the block-job-complete command after getting the ready event. (Since 2.0) If the base image is smaller than top, then the base image will be resized to be the same size as top. If top is smaller than the base image, the base will not be truncated. If you want the base image size to match the size of the smaller top, you can safely truncate it yourself once the commit operation successfully completes. 'speed: int' (optional) the maximum speed, in bytes per second 'filter-node-name: string' (optional) the node name that should be assigned to the filter driver that the commit job inserts into the graph above 'top'. If this option is not given, a node name is autogenerated. (Since: 2.9) 'auto-finalize: boolean' (optional) When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for 'block-job-finalize' before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) 'auto-dismiss: boolean' (optional) When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits 'block-job-dismiss'. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) Returns: Nothing on success If 'device' does not exist, DeviceNotFound Any other error returns a GenericError. Since: 1.3 Example: -> { "execute": "block-commit", "arguments": { "device": "virtio0", "top": "/tmp/snap1.qcow2" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: drive-backup Start a point-in-time copy of a block device to a new destination. The status of ongoing drive-backup operations can be checked with query-block-jobs where the BlockJobInfo.type field has the value 'backup'. The operation can be stopped before it has completed using the block-job-cancel command. Arguments: the members of 'DriveBackup' Returns: nothing on success If 'device' is not a valid block device, GenericError Since: 1.6 Example: -> { "execute": "drive-backup", "arguments": { "device": "drive0", "sync": "full", "target": "backup.img" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: blockdev-backup Start a point-in-time copy of a block device to a new destination. The status of ongoing blockdev-backup operations can be checked with query-block-jobs where the BlockJobInfo.type field has the value 'backup'. The operation can be stopped before it has completed using the block-job-cancel command. Arguments: the members of 'BlockdevBackup' Returns: nothing on success If 'device' is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound Since: 2.3 Example: -> { "execute": "blockdev-backup", "arguments": { "device": "src-id", "sync": "full", "target": "tgt-id" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: query-named-block-nodes Get the named block driver list Returns: the list of BlockDeviceInfo Since: 2.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-named-block-nodes" } <- { "return": [ { "ro":false, "drv":"qcow2", "encrypted":false, "file":"disks/test.qcow2", "node-name": "my-node", "backing_file_depth":1, "bps":1000000, "bps_rd":0, "bps_wr":0, "iops":1000000, "iops_rd":0, "iops_wr":0, "bps_max": 8000000, "bps_rd_max": 0, "bps_wr_max": 0, "iops_max": 0, "iops_rd_max": 0, "iops_wr_max": 0, "iops_size": 0, "write_threshold": 0, "image":{ "filename":"disks/test.qcow2", "format":"qcow2", "virtual-size":2048000, "backing_file":"base.qcow2", "full-backing-filename":"disks/base.qcow2", "backing-filename-format":"qcow2", "snapshots":[ { "id": "1", "name": "snapshot1", "vm-state-size": 0, "date-sec": 10000200, "date-nsec": 12, "vm-clock-sec": 206, "vm-clock-nsec": 30 } ], "backing-image":{ "filename":"disks/base.qcow2", "format":"qcow2", "virtual-size":2048000 } } } ] } -- Enum: XDbgBlockGraphNodeType Values: 'block-backend' corresponds to BlockBackend 'block-job' corresonds to BlockJob 'block-driver' corresponds to BlockDriverState Since: 4.0 -- Object: XDbgBlockGraphNode Members: 'id: int' Block graph node identifier. This 'id' is generated only for x-debug-query-block-graph and does not relate to any other identifiers in Qemu. 'type: XDbgBlockGraphNodeType' Type of graph node. Can be one of block-backend, block-job or block-driver-state. 'name: string' Human readable name of the node. Corresponds to node-name for block-driver-state nodes; is not guaranteed to be unique in the whole graph (with block-jobs and block-backends). Since: 4.0 -- Enum: BlockPermission Enum of base block permissions. Values: 'consistent-read' A user that has the "permission" of consistent reads is guaranteed that their view of the contents of the block device is complete and self-consistent, representing the contents of a disk at a specific point. For most block devices (including their backing files) this is true, but the property cannot be maintained in a few situations like for intermediate nodes of a commit block job. 'write' This permission is required to change the visible disk contents. 'write-unchanged' This permission (which is weaker than BLK_PERM_WRITE) is both enough and required for writes to the block node when the caller promises that the visible disk content doesn't change. As the BLK_PERM_WRITE permission is strictly stronger, either is sufficient to perform an unchanging write. 'resize' This permission is required to change the size of a block node. 'graph-mod' This permission is required to change the node that this BdrvChild points to. Since: 4.0 -- Object: XDbgBlockGraphEdge Block Graph edge description for x-debug-query-block-graph. Members: 'parent: int' parent id 'child: int' child id 'name: string' name of the relation (examples are 'file' and 'backing') 'perm: array of BlockPermission' granted permissions for the parent operating on the child 'shared-perm: array of BlockPermission' permissions that can still be granted to other users of the child while it is still attached to this parent Since: 4.0 -- Object: XDbgBlockGraph Block Graph - list of nodes and list of edges. Members: 'nodes: array of XDbgBlockGraphNode' Not documented 'edges: array of XDbgBlockGraphEdge' Not documented Since: 4.0 -- Command: x-debug-query-block-graph Get the block graph. Since: 4.0 -- Command: drive-mirror Start mirroring a block device's writes to a new destination. target specifies the target of the new image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, it will be used as the new destination for writes. If it does not exist, a new file will be created. format specifies the format of the mirror image, default is to probe if mode='existing', else the format of the source. Arguments: the members of 'DriveMirror' Returns: nothing on success If 'device' is not a valid block device, GenericError Since: 1.3 Example: -> { "execute": "drive-mirror", "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0", "target": "/some/place/my-image", "sync": "full", "format": "qcow2" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Object: DriveMirror A set of parameters describing drive mirror setup. Members: 'job-id: string' (optional) identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7) 'device: string' the device name or node-name of a root node whose writes should be mirrored. 'target: string' the target of the new image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, the existing file/device will be used as the new destination. If it does not exist, a new file will be created. 'format: string' (optional) the format of the new destination, default is to probe if 'mode' is 'existing', else the format of the source 'node-name: string' (optional) the new block driver state node name in the graph (Since 2.1) 'replaces: string' (optional) with sync=full graph node name to be replaced by the new image when a whole image copy is done. This can be used to repair broken Quorum files. (Since 2.1) 'mode: NewImageMode' (optional) whether and how QEMU should create a new image, default is 'absolute-paths'. 'speed: int' (optional) the maximum speed, in bytes per second 'sync: MirrorSyncMode' what parts of the disk image should be copied to the destination (all the disk, only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, or only new I/O). 'granularity: int' (optional) granularity of the dirty bitmap, default is 64K if the image format doesn't have clusters, 4K if the clusters are smaller than that, else the cluster size. Must be a power of 2 between 512 and 64M (since 1.4). 'buf-size: int' (optional) maximum amount of data in flight from source to target (since 1.4). 'on-source-error: BlockdevOnError' (optional) the action to take on an error on the source, default 'report'. 'stop' and 'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io-status (see BlockInfo). 'on-target-error: BlockdevOnError' (optional) the action to take on an error on the target, default 'report' (no limitations, since this applies to a different block device than 'device'). 'unmap: boolean' (optional) Whether to try to unmap target sectors where source has only zero. If true, and target unallocated sectors will read as zero, target image sectors will be unmapped; otherwise, zeroes will be written. Both will result in identical contents. Default is true. (Since 2.4) 'copy-mode: MirrorCopyMode' (optional) when to copy data to the destination; defaults to 'background' (Since: 3.0) 'auto-finalize: boolean' (optional) When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for 'block-job-finalize' before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) 'auto-dismiss: boolean' (optional) When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits 'block-job-dismiss'. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) Since: 1.3 -- Object: BlockDirtyBitmap Members: 'node: string' name of device/node which the bitmap is tracking 'name: string' name of the dirty bitmap Since: 2.4 -- Object: BlockDirtyBitmapAdd Members: 'node: string' name of device/node which the bitmap is tracking 'name: string' name of the dirty bitmap 'granularity: int' (optional) the bitmap granularity, default is 64k for block-dirty-bitmap-add 'persistent: boolean' (optional) the bitmap is persistent, i.e. it will be saved to the corresponding block device image file on its close. For now only Qcow2 disks support persistent bitmaps. Default is false for block-dirty-bitmap-add. (Since: 2.10) 'autoload: boolean' (optional) ignored and deprecated since 2.12. Currently, all dirty tracking bitmaps are loaded from Qcow2 on open. 'disabled: boolean' (optional) the bitmap is created in the disabled state, which means that it will not track drive changes. The bitmap may be enabled with block-dirty-bitmap-enable. Default is false. (Since: 4.0) Since: 2.4 -- Alternate: BlockDirtyBitmapMergeSource Members: 'local: string' name of the bitmap, attached to the same node as target bitmap. 'external: BlockDirtyBitmap' bitmap with specified node Since: 4.1 -- Object: BlockDirtyBitmapMerge Members: 'node: string' name of device/node which the 'target' bitmap is tracking 'target: string' name of the destination dirty bitmap 'bitmaps: array of BlockDirtyBitmapMergeSource' name(s) of the source dirty bitmap(s) at 'node' and/or fully specifed BlockDirtyBitmap elements. The latter are supported since 4.1. Since: 4.0 -- Command: block-dirty-bitmap-add Create a dirty bitmap with a name on the node, and start tracking the writes. Returns: nothing on success If 'node' is not a valid block device or node, DeviceNotFound If 'name' is already taken, GenericError with an explanation Since: 2.4 Example: -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-add", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: block-dirty-bitmap-remove Stop write tracking and remove the dirty bitmap that was created with block-dirty-bitmap-add. If the bitmap is persistent, remove it from its storage too. Returns: nothing on success If 'node' is not a valid block device or node, DeviceNotFound If 'name' is not found, GenericError with an explanation if 'name' is frozen by an operation, GenericError Since: 2.4 Example: -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-remove", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: block-dirty-bitmap-clear Clear (reset) a dirty bitmap on the device, so that an incremental backup from this point in time forward will only backup clusters modified after this clear operation. Returns: nothing on success If 'node' is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound If 'name' is not found, GenericError with an explanation Since: 2.4 Example: -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-clear", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: block-dirty-bitmap-enable Enables a dirty bitmap so that it will begin tracking disk changes. Returns: nothing on success If 'node' is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound If 'name' is not found, GenericError with an explanation Since: 4.0 Example: -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-enable", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: block-dirty-bitmap-disable Disables a dirty bitmap so that it will stop tracking disk changes. Returns: nothing on success If 'node' is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound If 'name' is not found, GenericError with an explanation Since: 4.0 Example: -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-disable", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: block-dirty-bitmap-merge Merge dirty bitmaps listed in 'bitmaps' to the 'target' dirty bitmap. Dirty bitmaps in 'bitmaps' will be unchanged, except if it also appears as the 'target' bitmap. Any bits already set in 'target' will still be set after the merge, i.e., this operation does not clear the target. On error, 'target' is unchanged. The resulting bitmap will count as dirty any clusters that were dirty in any of the source bitmaps. This can be used to achieve backup checkpoints, or in simpler usages, to copy bitmaps. Returns: nothing on success If 'node' is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound If any bitmap in 'bitmaps' or 'target' is not found, GenericError If any of the bitmaps have different sizes or granularities, GenericError Since: 4.0 Example: -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-merge", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "target": "bitmap0", "bitmaps": ["bitmap1"] } } <- { "return": {} } -- Object: BlockDirtyBitmapSha256 SHA256 hash of dirty bitmap data Members: 'sha256: string' ASCII representation of SHA256 bitmap hash Since: 2.10 -- Command: x-debug-block-dirty-bitmap-sha256 Get bitmap SHA256. Returns: BlockDirtyBitmapSha256 on success If 'node' is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound If 'name' is not found or if hashing has failed, GenericError with an explanation Since: 2.10 -- Command: blockdev-mirror Start mirroring a block device's writes to a new destination. Arguments: 'job-id: string' (optional) identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7) 'device: string' The device name or node-name of a root node whose writes should be mirrored. 'target: string' the id or node-name of the block device to mirror to. This mustn't be attached to guest. 'replaces: string' (optional) with sync=full graph node name to be replaced by the new image when a whole image copy is done. This can be used to repair broken Quorum files. 'speed: int' (optional) the maximum speed, in bytes per second 'sync: MirrorSyncMode' what parts of the disk image should be copied to the destination (all the disk, only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, or only new I/O). 'granularity: int' (optional) granularity of the dirty bitmap, default is 64K if the image format doesn't have clusters, 4K if the clusters are smaller than that, else the cluster size. Must be a power of 2 between 512 and 64M 'buf-size: int' (optional) maximum amount of data in flight from source to target 'on-source-error: BlockdevOnError' (optional) the action to take on an error on the source, default 'report'. 'stop' and 'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io-status (see BlockInfo). 'on-target-error: BlockdevOnError' (optional) the action to take on an error on the target, default 'report' (no limitations, since this applies to a different block device than 'device'). 'filter-node-name: string' (optional) the node name that should be assigned to the filter driver that the mirror job inserts into the graph above 'device'. If this option is not given, a node name is autogenerated. (Since: 2.9) 'copy-mode: MirrorCopyMode' (optional) when to copy data to the destination; defaults to 'background' (Since: 3.0) 'auto-finalize: boolean' (optional) When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for 'block-job-finalize' before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) 'auto-dismiss: boolean' (optional) When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits 'block-job-dismiss'. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) Returns: nothing on success. Since: 2.6 Example: -> { "execute": "blockdev-mirror", "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0", "target": "target0", "sync": "full" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: block_set_io_throttle Change I/O throttle limits for a block drive. Since QEMU 2.4, each device with I/O limits is member of a throttle group. If two or more devices are members of the same group, the limits will apply to the combined I/O of the whole group in a round-robin fashion. Therefore, setting new I/O limits to a device will affect the whole group. The name of the group can be specified using the 'group' parameter. If the parameter is unset, it is assumed to be the current group of that device. If it's not in any group yet, the name of the device will be used as the name for its group. The 'group' parameter can also be used to move a device to a different group. In this case the limits specified in the parameters will be applied to the new group only. I/O limits can be disabled by setting all of them to 0. In this case the device will be removed from its group and the rest of its members will not be affected. The 'group' parameter is ignored. Arguments: the members of 'BlockIOThrottle' Returns: Nothing on success If 'device' is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound Since: 1.1 Example: -> { "execute": "block_set_io_throttle", "arguments": { "id": "virtio-blk-pci0/virtio-backend", "bps": 0, "bps_rd": 0, "bps_wr": 0, "iops": 512, "iops_rd": 0, "iops_wr": 0, "bps_max": 0, "bps_rd_max": 0, "bps_wr_max": 0, "iops_max": 0, "iops_rd_max": 0, "iops_wr_max": 0, "bps_max_length": 0, "iops_size": 0 } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "block_set_io_throttle", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0", "bps": 1000000, "bps_rd": 0, "bps_wr": 0, "iops": 0, "iops_rd": 0, "iops_wr": 0, "bps_max": 8000000, "bps_rd_max": 0, "bps_wr_max": 0, "iops_max": 0, "iops_rd_max": 0, "iops_wr_max": 0, "bps_max_length": 60, "iops_size": 0 } } <- { "return": {} } -- Object: BlockIOThrottle A set of parameters describing block throttling. Members: 'device: string' (optional) Block device name (deprecated, use 'id' instead) 'id: string' (optional) The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8) 'bps: int' total throughput limit in bytes per second 'bps_rd: int' read throughput limit in bytes per second 'bps_wr: int' write throughput limit in bytes per second 'iops: int' total I/O operations per second 'iops_rd: int' read I/O operations per second 'iops_wr: int' write I/O operations per second 'bps_max: int' (optional) total throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) 'bps_rd_max: int' (optional) read throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) 'bps_wr_max: int' (optional) write throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) 'iops_max: int' (optional) total I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) 'iops_rd_max: int' (optional) read I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) 'iops_wr_max: int' (optional) write I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) 'bps_max_length: int' (optional) maximum length of the 'bps_max' burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if 'bps_max' is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6) 'bps_rd_max_length: int' (optional) maximum length of the 'bps_rd_max' burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if 'bps_rd_max' is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6) 'bps_wr_max_length: int' (optional) maximum length of the 'bps_wr_max' burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if 'bps_wr_max' is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6) 'iops_max_length: int' (optional) maximum length of the 'iops' burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if 'iops_max' is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6) 'iops_rd_max_length: int' (optional) maximum length of the 'iops_rd_max' burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if 'iops_rd_max' is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6) 'iops_wr_max_length: int' (optional) maximum length of the 'iops_wr_max' burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if 'iops_wr_max' is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6) 'iops_size: int' (optional) an I/O size in bytes (Since 1.7) 'group: string' (optional) throttle group name (Since 2.4) Since: 1.1 -- Object: ThrottleLimits Limit parameters for throttling. Since some limit combinations are illegal, limits should always be set in one transaction. All fields are optional. When setting limits, if a field is missing the current value is not changed. Members: 'iops-total: int' (optional) limit total I/O operations per second 'iops-total-max: int' (optional) I/O operations burst 'iops-total-max-length: int' (optional) length of the iops-total-max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if 'iops-total-max' is set as well. 'iops-read: int' (optional) limit read operations per second 'iops-read-max: int' (optional) I/O operations read burst 'iops-read-max-length: int' (optional) length of the iops-read-max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if 'iops-read-max' is set as well. 'iops-write: int' (optional) limit write operations per second 'iops-write-max: int' (optional) I/O operations write burst 'iops-write-max-length: int' (optional) length of the iops-write-max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if 'iops-write-max' is set as well. 'bps-total: int' (optional) limit total bytes per second 'bps-total-max: int' (optional) total bytes burst 'bps-total-max-length: int' (optional) length of the bps-total-max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if 'bps-total-max' is set as well. 'bps-read: int' (optional) limit read bytes per second 'bps-read-max: int' (optional) total bytes read burst 'bps-read-max-length: int' (optional) length of the bps-read-max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if 'bps-read-max' is set as well. 'bps-write: int' (optional) limit write bytes per second 'bps-write-max: int' (optional) total bytes write burst 'bps-write-max-length: int' (optional) length of the bps-write-max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if 'bps-write-max' is set as well. 'iops-size: int' (optional) when limiting by iops max size of an I/O in bytes Since: 2.11 -- Command: block-stream Copy data from a backing file into a block device. The block streaming operation is performed in the background until the entire backing file has been copied. This command returns immediately once streaming has started. The status of ongoing block streaming operations can be checked with query-block-jobs. The operation can be stopped before it has completed using the block-job-cancel command. The node that receives the data is called the top image, can be located in any part of the chain (but always above the base image; see below) and can be specified using its device or node name. Earlier qemu versions only allowed 'device' to name the top level node; presence of the 'base-node' parameter during introspection can be used as a witness of the enhanced semantics of 'device'. If a base file is specified then sectors are not copied from that base file and its backing chain. When streaming completes the image file will have the base file as its backing file. This can be used to stream a subset of the backing file chain instead of flattening the entire image. On successful completion the image file is updated to drop the backing file and the BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED event is emitted. Arguments: 'job-id: string' (optional) identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7) 'device: string' the device or node name of the top image 'base: string' (optional) the common backing file name. It cannot be set if 'base-node' is also set. 'base-node: string' (optional) the node name of the backing file. It cannot be set if 'base' is also set. (Since 2.8) 'backing-file: string' (optional) The backing file string to write into the top image. This filename is not validated. If a pathname string is such that it cannot be resolved by QEMU, that means that subsequent QMP or HMP commands must use node-names for the image in question, as filename lookup methods will fail. If not specified, QEMU will automatically determine the backing file string to use, or error out if there is no obvious choice. Care should be taken when specifying the string, to specify a valid filename or protocol. (Since 2.1) 'speed: int' (optional) the maximum speed, in bytes per second 'on-error: BlockdevOnError' (optional) the action to take on an error (default report). 'stop' and 'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io-status (see BlockInfo). Since 1.3. 'auto-finalize: boolean' (optional) When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for 'block-job-finalize' before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) 'auto-dismiss: boolean' (optional) When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits 'block-job-dismiss'. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) Returns: Nothing on success. If 'device' does not exist, DeviceNotFound. Since: 1.1 Example: -> { "execute": "block-stream", "arguments": { "device": "virtio0", "base": "/tmp/master.qcow2" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: block-job-set-speed Set maximum speed for a background block operation. This command can only be issued when there is an active block job. Throttling can be disabled by setting the speed to 0. Arguments: 'device: string' The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values. 'speed: int' the maximum speed, in bytes per second, or 0 for unlimited. Defaults to 0. Returns: Nothing on success If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive Since: 1.1 -- Command: block-job-cancel Stop an active background block operation. This command returns immediately after marking the active background block operation for cancellation. It is an error to call this command if no operation is in progress. The operation will cancel as soon as possible and then emit the BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED event. Before that happens the job is still visible when enumerated using query-block-jobs. Note that if you issue 'block-job-cancel' after 'drive-mirror' has indicated (via the event BLOCK_JOB_READY) that the source and destination are synchronized, then the event triggered by this command changes to BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED, to indicate that the mirroring has ended and the destination now has a point-in-time copy tied to the time of the cancellation. For streaming, the image file retains its backing file unless the streaming operation happens to complete just as it is being cancelled. A new streaming operation can be started at a later time to finish copying all data from the backing file. Arguments: 'device: string' The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values. 'force: boolean' (optional) If true, and the job has already emitted the event BLOCK_JOB_READY, abandon the job immediately (even if it is paused) instead of waiting for the destination to complete its final synchronization (since 1.3) Returns: Nothing on success If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive Since: 1.1 -- Command: block-job-pause Pause an active background block operation. This command returns immediately after marking the active background block operation for pausing. It is an error to call this command if no operation is in progress or if the job is already paused. The operation will pause as soon as possible. No event is emitted when the operation is actually paused. Cancelling a paused job automatically resumes it. Arguments: 'device: string' The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values. Returns: Nothing on success If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive Since: 1.3 -- Command: block-job-resume Resume an active background block operation. This command returns immediately after resuming a paused background block operation. It is an error to call this command if no operation is in progress or if the job is not paused. This command also clears the error status of the job. Arguments: 'device: string' The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values. Returns: Nothing on success If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive Since: 1.3 -- Command: block-job-complete Manually trigger completion of an active background block operation. This is supported for drive mirroring, where it also switches the device to write to the target path only. The ability to complete is signaled with a BLOCK_JOB_READY event. This command completes an active background block operation synchronously. The ordering of this command's return with the BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED event is not defined. Note that if an I/O error occurs during the processing of this command: 1) the command itself will fail; 2) the error will be processed according to the rerror/werror arguments that were specified when starting the operation. A cancelled or paused job cannot be completed. Arguments: 'device: string' The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values. Returns: Nothing on success If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive Since: 1.3 -- Command: block-job-dismiss For jobs that have already concluded, remove them from the block-job-query list. This command only needs to be run for jobs which were started with QEMU 2.12+ job lifetime management semantics. This command will refuse to operate on any job that has not yet reached its terminal state, JOB_STATUS_CONCLUDED. For jobs that make use of the BLOCK_JOB_READY event, block-job-cancel or block-job-complete will still need to be used as appropriate. Arguments: 'id: string' The job identifier. Returns: Nothing on success Since: 2.12 -- Command: block-job-finalize Once a job that has manual=true reaches the pending state, it can be instructed to finalize any graph changes and do any necessary cleanup via this command. For jobs in a transaction, instructing one job to finalize will force ALL jobs in the transaction to finalize, so it is only necessary to instruct a single member job to finalize. Arguments: 'id: string' The job identifier. Returns: Nothing on success Since: 2.12 -- Enum: BlockdevDiscardOptions Determines how to handle discard requests. Values: 'ignore' Ignore the request 'unmap' Forward as an unmap request Since: 2.9 -- Enum: BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions Describes the operation mode for the automatic conversion of plain zero writes by the OS to driver specific optimized zero write commands. Values: 'off' Disabled (default) 'on' Enabled 'unmap' Enabled and even try to unmap blocks if possible. This requires also that 'BlockdevDiscardOptions' is set to unmap for this device. Since: 2.1 -- Enum: BlockdevAioOptions Selects the AIO backend to handle I/O requests Values: 'threads' Use qemu's thread pool 'native' Use native AIO backend (only Linux and Windows) Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevCacheOptions Includes cache-related options for block devices Members: 'direct: boolean' (optional) enables use of O_DIRECT (bypass the host page cache; default: false) 'no-flush: boolean' (optional) ignore any flush requests for the device (default: false) Since: 2.9 -- Enum: BlockdevDriver Drivers that are supported in block device operations. Values: 'vxhs' Since 2.10 'throttle' Since 2.11 'nvme' Since 2.12 'copy-on-read' Since 3.0 'blklogwrites' Since 3.0 'blkdebug' Not documented 'blkverify' Not documented 'bochs' Not documented 'cloop' Not documented 'dmg' Not documented 'file' Not documented 'ftp' Not documented 'ftps' Not documented 'gluster' Not documented 'host_cdrom' Not documented 'host_device' Not documented 'http' Not documented 'https' Not documented 'iscsi' Not documented 'luks' Not documented 'nbd' Not documented 'nfs' Not documented 'null-aio' Not documented 'null-co' Not documented 'parallels' Not documented 'qcow' Not documented 'qcow2' Not documented 'qed' Not documented 'quorum' Not documented 'raw' Not documented 'rbd' Not documented 'replication' Not documented If: 'defined(CONFIG_REPLICATION)' 'sheepdog' Not documented 'ssh' Not documented 'vdi' Not documented 'vhdx' Not documented 'vmdk' Not documented 'vpc' Not documented 'vvfat' Not documented Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsFile Driver specific block device options for the file backend. Members: 'filename: string' path to the image file 'pr-manager: string' (optional) the id for the object that will handle persistent reservations for this device (default: none, forward the commands via SG_IO; since 2.11) 'aio: BlockdevAioOptions' (optional) AIO backend (default: threads) (since: 2.8) 'locking: OnOffAuto' (optional) whether to enable file locking. If set to 'auto', only enable when Open File Descriptor (OFD) locking API is available (default: auto, since 2.10) 'drop-cache: boolean' (optional) invalidate page cache during live migration. This prevents stale data on the migration destination with cache.direct=off. Currently only supported on Linux hosts. (default: on, since: 4.0) If: 'defined(CONFIG_LINUX)' 'x-check-cache-dropped: boolean' (optional) whether to check that page cache was dropped on live migration. May cause noticeable delays if the image file is large, do not use in production. (default: off) (since: 3.0) Features: 'dynamic-auto-read-only' If present, enabled auto-read-only means that the driver will open the image read-only at first, dynamically reopen the image file read-write when the first writer is attached to the node and reopen read-only when the last writer is detached. This allows giving QEMU write permissions only on demand when an operation actually needs write access. Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsNull Driver specific block device options for the null backend. Members: 'size: int' (optional) size of the device in bytes. 'latency-ns: int' (optional) emulated latency (in nanoseconds) in processing requests. Default to zero which completes requests immediately. (Since 2.4) 'read-zeroes: boolean' (optional) if true, reads from the device produce zeroes; if false, the buffer is left unchanged. (default: false; since: 4.1) Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsNVMe Driver specific block device options for the NVMe backend. Members: 'device: string' controller address of the NVMe device. 'namespace: int' namespace number of the device, starting from 1. Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsVVFAT Driver specific block device options for the vvfat protocol. Members: 'dir: string' directory to be exported as FAT image 'fat-type: int' (optional) FAT type: 12, 16 or 32 'floppy: boolean' (optional) whether to export a floppy image (true) or partitioned hard disk (false; default) 'label: string' (optional) set the volume label, limited to 11 bytes. FAT16 and FAT32 traditionally have some restrictions on labels, which are ignored by most operating systems. Defaults to "QEMU VVFAT". (since 2.4) 'rw: boolean' (optional) whether to allow write operations (default: false) Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat Driver specific block device options for image format that have no option besides their data source. Members: 'file: BlockdevRef' reference to or definition of the data source block device Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsLUKS Driver specific block device options for LUKS. Members: 'key-secret: string' (optional) the ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the decryption key (since 2.6). Mandatory except when doing a metadata-only probe of the image. The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat' Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat Driver specific block device options for image format that have no option besides their data source and an optional backing file. Members: 'backing: BlockdevRefOrNull' (optional) reference to or definition of the backing file block device, null disables the backing file entirely. Defaults to the backing file stored the image file. The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat' Since: 2.9 -- Enum: Qcow2OverlapCheckMode General overlap check modes. Values: 'none' Do not perform any checks 'constant' Perform only checks which can be done in constant time and without reading anything from disk 'cached' Perform only checks which can be done without reading anything from disk 'all' Perform all available overlap checks Since: 2.9 -- Object: Qcow2OverlapCheckFlags Structure of flags for each metadata structure. Setting a field to 'true' makes qemu guard that structure against unintended overwriting. The default value is chosen according to the template given. Members: 'template: Qcow2OverlapCheckMode' (optional) Specifies a template mode which can be adjusted using the other flags, defaults to 'cached' 'bitmap-directory: boolean' (optional) since 3.0 'main-header: boolean' (optional) Not documented 'active-l1: boolean' (optional) Not documented 'active-l2: boolean' (optional) Not documented 'refcount-table: boolean' (optional) Not documented 'refcount-block: boolean' (optional) Not documented 'snapshot-table: boolean' (optional) Not documented 'inactive-l1: boolean' (optional) Not documented 'inactive-l2: boolean' (optional) Not documented Since: 2.9 -- Alternate: Qcow2OverlapChecks Specifies which metadata structures should be guarded against unintended overwriting. Members: 'flags: Qcow2OverlapCheckFlags' set of flags for separate specification of each metadata structure type 'mode: Qcow2OverlapCheckMode' named mode which chooses a specific set of flags Since: 2.9 -- Enum: BlockdevQcowEncryptionFormat Values: 'aes' AES-CBC with plain64 initialization vectors Since: 2.10 -- Object: BlockdevQcowEncryption Members: 'format: BlockdevQcowEncryptionFormat' Not documented The members of 'QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow' when 'format' is "aes" Since: 2.10 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsQcow Driver specific block device options for qcow. Members: 'encrypt: BlockdevQcowEncryption' (optional) Image decryption options. Mandatory for encrypted images, except when doing a metadata-only probe of the image. The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat' Since: 2.10 -- Enum: BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat Values: 'aes' AES-CBC with plain64 initialization vectors 'luks' Not documented Since: 2.10 -- Object: BlockdevQcow2Encryption Members: 'format: BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat' Not documented The members of 'QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow' when 'format' is "aes" The members of 'QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS' when 'format' is "luks" Since: 2.10 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsQcow2 Driver specific block device options for qcow2. Members: 'lazy-refcounts: boolean' (optional) whether to enable the lazy refcounts feature (default is taken from the image file) 'pass-discard-request: boolean' (optional) whether discard requests to the qcow2 device should be forwarded to the data source 'pass-discard-snapshot: boolean' (optional) whether discard requests for the data source should be issued when a snapshot operation (e.g. deleting a snapshot) frees clusters in the qcow2 file 'pass-discard-other: boolean' (optional) whether discard requests for the data source should be issued on other occasions where a cluster gets freed 'overlap-check: Qcow2OverlapChecks' (optional) which overlap checks to perform for writes to the image, defaults to 'cached' (since 2.2) 'cache-size: int' (optional) the maximum total size of the L2 table and refcount block caches in bytes (since 2.2) 'l2-cache-size: int' (optional) the maximum size of the L2 table cache in bytes (since 2.2) 'l2-cache-entry-size: int' (optional) the size of each entry in the L2 cache in bytes. It must be a power of two between 512 and the cluster size. The default value is the cluster size (since 2.12) 'refcount-cache-size: int' (optional) the maximum size of the refcount block cache in bytes (since 2.2) 'cache-clean-interval: int' (optional) clean unused entries in the L2 and refcount caches. The interval is in seconds. The default value is 600 on supporting platforms, and 0 on other platforms. 0 disables this feature. (since 2.5) 'encrypt: BlockdevQcow2Encryption' (optional) Image decryption options. Mandatory for encrypted images, except when doing a metadata-only probe of the image. (since 2.10) 'data-file: BlockdevRef' (optional) reference to or definition of the external data file. This may only be specified for images that require an external data file. If it is not specified for such an image, the data file name is loaded from the image file. (since 4.0) The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat' Since: 2.9 -- Enum: SshHostKeyCheckMode 'none' Don't check the host key at all 'hash' Compare the host key with a given hash 'known_hosts' Check the host key against the known_hosts file Values: 'none' Not documented 'hash' Not documented 'known_hosts' Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Enum: SshHostKeyCheckHashType 'md5' The given hash is an md5 hash 'sha1' The given hash is an sha1 hash Values: 'md5' Not documented 'sha1' Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: SshHostKeyHash 'type' The hash algorithm used for the hash 'hash' The expected hash value Members: 'type: SshHostKeyCheckHashType' Not documented 'hash: string' Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: SshHostKeyCheck Members: 'mode: SshHostKeyCheckMode' Not documented The members of 'SshHostKeyHash' when 'mode' is "hash" Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsSsh Members: 'server: InetSocketAddress' host address 'path: string' path to the image on the host 'user: string' (optional) user as which to connect, defaults to current local user name 'host-key-check: SshHostKeyCheck' (optional) Defines how and what to check the host key against (default: known_hosts) Since: 2.9 -- Enum: BlkdebugEvent Trigger events supported by blkdebug. Values: 'l1_shrink_write_table' write zeros to the l1 table to shrink image. (since 2.11) 'l1_shrink_free_l2_clusters' discard the l2 tables. (since 2.11) 'cor_write' a write due to copy-on-read (since 2.11) 'cluster_alloc_space' an allocation of file space for a cluster (since 4.1) 'none' triggers once at creation of the blkdebug node (since 4.1) 'l1_update' Not documented 'l1_grow_alloc_table' Not documented 'l1_grow_write_table' Not documented 'l1_grow_activate_table' Not documented 'l2_load' Not documented 'l2_update' Not documented 'l2_update_compressed' Not documented 'l2_alloc_cow_read' Not documented 'l2_alloc_write' Not documented 'read_aio' Not documented 'read_backing_aio' Not documented 'read_compressed' Not documented 'write_aio' Not documented 'write_compressed' Not documented 'vmstate_load' Not documented 'vmstate_save' Not documented 'cow_read' Not documented 'cow_write' Not documented 'reftable_load' Not documented 'reftable_grow' Not documented 'reftable_update' Not documented 'refblock_load' Not documented 'refblock_update' Not documented 'refblock_update_part' Not documented 'refblock_alloc' Not documented 'refblock_alloc_hookup' Not documented 'refblock_alloc_write' Not documented 'refblock_alloc_write_blocks' Not documented 'refblock_alloc_write_table' Not documented 'refblock_alloc_switch_table' Not documented 'cluster_alloc' Not documented 'cluster_alloc_bytes' Not documented 'cluster_free' Not documented 'flush_to_os' Not documented 'flush_to_disk' Not documented 'pwritev_rmw_head' Not documented 'pwritev_rmw_after_head' Not documented 'pwritev_rmw_tail' Not documented 'pwritev_rmw_after_tail' Not documented 'pwritev' Not documented 'pwritev_zero' Not documented 'pwritev_done' Not documented 'empty_image_prepare' Not documented Since: 2.9 -- Enum: BlkdebugIOType Kinds of I/O that blkdebug can inject errors in. Values: 'read' .bdrv_co_preadv() 'write' .bdrv_co_pwritev() 'write-zeroes' .bdrv_co_pwrite_zeroes() 'discard' .bdrv_co_pdiscard() 'flush' .bdrv_co_flush_to_disk() 'block-status' .bdrv_co_block_status() Since: 4.1 -- Object: BlkdebugInjectErrorOptions Describes a single error injection for blkdebug. Members: 'event: BlkdebugEvent' trigger event 'state: int' (optional) the state identifier blkdebug needs to be in to actually trigger the event; defaults to "any" 'iotype: BlkdebugIOType' (optional) the type of I/O operations on which this error should be injected; defaults to "all read, write, write-zeroes, discard, and flush operations" (since: 4.1) 'errno: int' (optional) error identifier (errno) to be returned; defaults to EIO 'sector: int' (optional) specifies the sector index which has to be affected in order to actually trigger the event; defaults to "any sector" 'once: boolean' (optional) disables further events after this one has been triggered; defaults to false 'immediately: boolean' (optional) fail immediately; defaults to false Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlkdebugSetStateOptions Describes a single state-change event for blkdebug. Members: 'event: BlkdebugEvent' trigger event 'state: int' (optional) the current state identifier blkdebug needs to be in; defaults to "any" 'new_state: int' the state identifier blkdebug is supposed to assume if this event is triggered Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsBlkdebug Driver specific block device options for blkdebug. Members: 'image: BlockdevRef' underlying raw block device (or image file) 'config: string' (optional) filename of the configuration file 'align: int' (optional) required alignment for requests in bytes, must be positive power of 2, or 0 for default 'max-transfer: int' (optional) maximum size for I/O transfers in bytes, must be positive multiple of 'align' and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10) 'opt-write-zero: int' (optional) preferred alignment for write zero requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of 'align' and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10) 'max-write-zero: int' (optional) maximum size for write zero requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of 'align', of 'opt-write-zero', and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10) 'opt-discard: int' (optional) preferred alignment for discard requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of 'align' and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10) 'max-discard: int' (optional) maximum size for discard requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of 'align', of 'opt-discard', and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10) 'inject-error: array of BlkdebugInjectErrorOptions' (optional) array of error injection descriptions 'set-state: array of BlkdebugSetStateOptions' (optional) array of state-change descriptions Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsBlklogwrites Driver specific block device options for blklogwrites. Members: 'file: BlockdevRef' block device 'log: BlockdevRef' block device used to log writes to 'file' 'log-sector-size: int' (optional) sector size used in logging writes to 'file', determines granularity of offsets and sizes of writes (default: 512) 'log-append: boolean' (optional) append to an existing log (default: false) 'log-super-update-interval: int' (optional) interval of write requests after which the log super block is updated to disk (default: 4096) Since: 3.0 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsBlkverify Driver specific block device options for blkverify. Members: 'test: BlockdevRef' block device to be tested 'raw: BlockdevRef' raw image used for verification Since: 2.9 -- Enum: QuorumReadPattern An enumeration of quorum read patterns. Values: 'quorum' read all the children and do a quorum vote on reads 'fifo' read only from the first child that has not failed Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsQuorum Driver specific block device options for Quorum Members: 'blkverify: boolean' (optional) true if the driver must print content mismatch set to false by default 'children: array of BlockdevRef' the children block devices to use 'vote-threshold: int' the vote limit under which a read will fail 'rewrite-corrupted: boolean' (optional) rewrite corrupted data when quorum is reached (Since 2.1) 'read-pattern: QuorumReadPattern' (optional) choose read pattern and set to quorum by default (Since 2.2) Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsGluster Driver specific block device options for Gluster Members: 'volume: string' name of gluster volume where VM image resides 'path: string' absolute path to image file in gluster volume 'server: array of SocketAddress' gluster servers description 'debug: int' (optional) libgfapi log level (default '4' which is Error) (Since 2.8) 'logfile: string' (optional) libgfapi log file (default /dev/stderr) (Since 2.8) Since: 2.9 -- Enum: IscsiTransport An enumeration of libiscsi transport types Values: 'tcp' Not documented 'iser' Not documented Since: 2.9 -- Enum: IscsiHeaderDigest An enumeration of header digests supported by libiscsi Values: 'crc32c' Not documented 'none' Not documented 'crc32c-none' Not documented 'none-crc32c' Not documented Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsIscsi Members: 'transport: IscsiTransport' The iscsi transport type 'portal: string' The address of the iscsi portal 'target: string' The target iqn name 'lun: int' (optional) LUN to connect to. Defaults to 0. 'user: string' (optional) User name to log in with. If omitted, no CHAP authentication is performed. 'password-secret: string' (optional) The ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the password for the login. This option is required if 'user' is specified. 'initiator-name: string' (optional) The iqn name we want to identify to the target as. If this option is not specified, an initiator name is generated automatically. 'header-digest: IscsiHeaderDigest' (optional) The desired header digest. Defaults to none-crc32c. 'timeout: int' (optional) Timeout in seconds after which a request will timeout. 0 means no timeout and is the default. Driver specific block device options for iscsi Since: 2.9 -- Enum: RbdAuthMode Values: 'cephx' Not documented 'none' Not documented Since: 3.0 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsRbd Members: 'pool: string' Ceph pool name. 'image: string' Image name in the Ceph pool. 'conf: string' (optional) path to Ceph configuration file. Values in the configuration file will be overridden by options specified via QAPI. 'snapshot: string' (optional) Ceph snapshot name. 'user: string' (optional) Ceph id name. 'auth-client-required: array of RbdAuthMode' (optional) Acceptable authentication modes. This maps to Ceph configuration option "auth_client_required". (Since 3.0) 'key-secret: string' (optional) ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a key for cephx authentication. This maps to Ceph configuration option "key". (Since 3.0) 'server: array of InetSocketAddressBase' (optional) Monitor host address and port. This maps to the "mon_host" Ceph option. Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsSheepdog Driver specific block device options for sheepdog Members: 'vdi: string' Virtual disk image name 'server: SocketAddress' The Sheepdog server to connect to 'snap-id: int' (optional) Snapshot ID 'tag: string' (optional) Snapshot tag name Only one of 'snap-id' and 'tag' may be present. Since: 2.9 -- Enum: ReplicationMode An enumeration of replication modes. Values: 'primary' Primary mode, the vm's state will be sent to secondary QEMU. 'secondary' Secondary mode, receive the vm's state from primary QEMU. Since: 2.9 If: 'defined(CONFIG_REPLICATION)' -- Object: BlockdevOptionsReplication Driver specific block device options for replication Members: 'mode: ReplicationMode' the replication mode 'top-id: string' (optional) In secondary mode, node name or device ID of the root node who owns the replication node chain. Must not be given in primary mode. The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat' Since: 2.9 If: 'defined(CONFIG_REPLICATION)' -- Enum: NFSTransport An enumeration of NFS transport types Values: 'inet' TCP transport Since: 2.9 -- Object: NFSServer Captures the address of the socket Members: 'type: NFSTransport' transport type used for NFS (only TCP supported) 'host: string' host address for NFS server Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsNfs Driver specific block device option for NFS Members: 'server: NFSServer' host address 'path: string' path of the image on the host 'user: int' (optional) UID value to use when talking to the server (defaults to 65534 on Windows and getuid() on unix) 'group: int' (optional) GID value to use when talking to the server (defaults to 65534 on Windows and getgid() in unix) 'tcp-syn-count: int' (optional) number of SYNs during the session establishment (defaults to libnfs default) 'readahead-size: int' (optional) set the readahead size in bytes (defaults to libnfs default) 'page-cache-size: int' (optional) set the pagecache size in bytes (defaults to libnfs default) 'debug: int' (optional) set the NFS debug level (max 2) (defaults to libnfs default) Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsCurlBase Driver specific block device options shared by all protocols supported by the curl backend. Members: 'url: string' URL of the image file 'readahead: int' (optional) Size of the read-ahead cache; must be a multiple of 512 (defaults to 256 kB) 'timeout: int' (optional) Timeout for connections, in seconds (defaults to 5) 'username: string' (optional) Username for authentication (defaults to none) 'password-secret: string' (optional) ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a password for authentication (defaults to no password) 'proxy-username: string' (optional) Username for proxy authentication (defaults to none) 'proxy-password-secret: string' (optional) ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a password for proxy authentication (defaults to no password) Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsCurlHttp Driver specific block device options for HTTP connections over the curl backend. URLs must start with "http://". Members: 'cookie: string' (optional) List of cookies to set; format is "name1=content1; name2=content2;" as explained by CURLOPT_COOKIE(3). Defaults to no cookies. 'cookie-secret: string' (optional) ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the cookie data in a secure way. See 'cookie' for the format. (since 2.10) The members of 'BlockdevOptionsCurlBase' Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsCurlHttps Driver specific block device options for HTTPS connections over the curl backend. URLs must start with "https://". Members: 'cookie: string' (optional) List of cookies to set; format is "name1=content1; name2=content2;" as explained by CURLOPT_COOKIE(3). Defaults to no cookies. 'sslverify: boolean' (optional) Whether to verify the SSL certificate's validity (defaults to true) 'cookie-secret: string' (optional) ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the cookie data in a secure way. See 'cookie' for the format. (since 2.10) The members of 'BlockdevOptionsCurlBase' Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsCurlFtp Driver specific block device options for FTP connections over the curl backend. URLs must start with "ftp://". Members: The members of 'BlockdevOptionsCurlBase' Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsCurlFtps Driver specific block device options for FTPS connections over the curl backend. URLs must start with "ftps://". Members: 'sslverify: boolean' (optional) Whether to verify the SSL certificate's validity (defaults to true) The members of 'BlockdevOptionsCurlBase' Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsNbd Driver specific block device options for NBD. Members: 'server: SocketAddress' NBD server address 'export: string' (optional) export name 'tls-creds: string' (optional) TLS credentials ID 'x-dirty-bitmap: string' (optional) A "qemu:dirty-bitmap:NAME" string to query in place of traditional "base:allocation" block status (see NBD_OPT_LIST_META_CONTEXT in the NBD protocol) (since 3.0) Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsRaw Driver specific block device options for the raw driver. Members: 'offset: int' (optional) position where the block device starts 'size: int' (optional) the assumed size of the device The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat' Since: 2.9 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsVxHS Driver specific block device options for VxHS Members: 'vdisk-id: string' UUID of VxHS volume 'server: InetSocketAddressBase' vxhs server IP, port 'tls-creds: string' (optional) TLS credentials ID Since: 2.10 -- Object: BlockdevOptionsThrottle Driver specific block device options for the throttle driver Members: 'throttle-group: string' the name of the throttle-group object to use. It must already exist. 'file: BlockdevRef' reference to or definition of the data source block device Since: 2.11 -- Object: BlockdevOptions Options for creating a block device. Many options are available for all block devices, independent of the block driver: Members: 'driver: BlockdevDriver' block driver name 'node-name: string' (optional) the node name of the new node (Since 2.0). This option is required on the top level of blockdev-add. Valid node names start with an alphabetic character and may contain only alphanumeric characters, '-', '.' and '_'. Their maximum length is 31 characters. 'discard: BlockdevDiscardOptions' (optional) discard-related options (default: ignore) 'cache: BlockdevCacheOptions' (optional) cache-related options 'read-only: boolean' (optional) whether the block device should be read-only (default: false). Note that some block drivers support only read-only access, either generally or in certain configurations. In this case, the default value does not work and the option must be specified explicitly. 'auto-read-only: boolean' (optional) if true and 'read-only' is false, QEMU may automatically decide not to open the image read-write as requested, but fall back to read-only instead (and switch between the modes later), e.g. depending on whether the image file is writable or whether a writing user is attached to the node (default: false, since 3.1) 'detect-zeroes: BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions' (optional) detect and optimize zero writes (Since 2.1) (default: off) 'force-share: boolean' (optional) force share all permission on added nodes. Requires read-only=true. (Since 2.10) The members of 'BlockdevOptionsBlkdebug' when 'driver' is "blkdebug" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsBlklogwrites' when 'driver' is "blklogwrites" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsBlkverify' when 'driver' is "blkverify" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat' when 'driver' is "bochs" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat' when 'driver' is "cloop" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat' when 'driver' is "copy-on-read" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat' when 'driver' is "dmg" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsFile' when 'driver' is "file" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsCurlFtp' when 'driver' is "ftp" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsCurlFtps' when 'driver' is "ftps" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGluster' when 'driver' is "gluster" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsFile' when 'driver' is "host_cdrom" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsFile' when 'driver' is "host_device" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsCurlHttp' when 'driver' is "http" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsCurlHttps' when 'driver' is "https" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsIscsi' when 'driver' is "iscsi" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsLUKS' when 'driver' is "luks" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsNbd' when 'driver' is "nbd" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsNfs' when 'driver' is "nfs" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsNull' when 'driver' is "null-aio" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsNull' when 'driver' is "null-co" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsNVMe' when 'driver' is "nvme" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat' when 'driver' is "parallels" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsQcow2' when 'driver' is "qcow2" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsQcow' when 'driver' is "qcow" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat' when 'driver' is "qed" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsQuorum' when 'driver' is "quorum" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsRaw' when 'driver' is "raw" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsRbd' when 'driver' is "rbd" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsReplication' when 'driver' is "replication" (If: 'defined(CONFIG_REPLICATION)') The members of 'BlockdevOptionsSheepdog' when 'driver' is "sheepdog" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsSsh' when 'driver' is "ssh" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsThrottle' when 'driver' is "throttle" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat' when 'driver' is "vdi" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat' when 'driver' is "vhdx" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat' when 'driver' is "vmdk" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat' when 'driver' is "vpc" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsVVFAT' when 'driver' is "vvfat" The members of 'BlockdevOptionsVxHS' when 'driver' is "vxhs" Remaining options are determined by the block driver. Since: 2.9 -- Alternate: BlockdevRef Reference to a block device. Members: 'definition: BlockdevOptions' defines a new block device inline 'reference: string' references the ID of an existing block device Since: 2.9 -- Alternate: BlockdevRefOrNull Reference to a block device. Members: 'definition: BlockdevOptions' defines a new block device inline 'reference: string' references the ID of an existing block device. An empty string means that no block device should be referenced. Deprecated; use null instead. 'null: null' No block device should be referenced (since 2.10) Since: 2.9 -- Command: blockdev-add Creates a new block device. If the 'id' option is given at the top level, a BlockBackend will be created; otherwise, 'node-name' is mandatory at the top level and no BlockBackend will be created. Arguments: the members of 'BlockdevOptions' Since: 2.9 Example: 1. -> { "execute": "blockdev-add", "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2", "node-name": "test1", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "test.qcow2" } } } <- { "return": {} } 2. -> { "execute": "blockdev-add", "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2", "node-name": "node0", "discard": "unmap", "cache": { "direct": true }, "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "/tmp/test.qcow2" }, "backing": { "driver": "raw", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "/dev/fdset/4" } } } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: x-blockdev-reopen Reopens a block device using the given set of options. Any option not specified will be reset to its default value regardless of its previous status. If an option cannot be changed or a particular driver does not support reopening then the command will return an error. The top-level 'node-name' option (from BlockdevOptions) must be specified and is used to select the block device to be reopened. Other 'node-name' options must be either omitted or set to the current name of the appropriate node. This command won't change any node name and any attempt to do it will result in an error. In the case of options that refer to child nodes, the behavior of this command depends on the value: 1) A set of options (BlockdevOptions): the child is reopened with the specified set of options. 2) A reference to the current child: the child is reopened using its existing set of options. 3) A reference to a different node: the current child is replaced with the specified one. 4) NULL: the current child (if any) is detached. Options (1) and (2) are supported in all cases, but at the moment only 'backing' allows replacing or detaching an existing child. Unlike with blockdev-add, the 'backing' option must always be present unless the node being reopened does not have a backing file and its image does not have a default backing file name as part of its metadata. Arguments: the members of 'BlockdevOptions' Since: 4.0 -- Command: blockdev-del Deletes a block device that has been added using blockdev-add. The command will fail if the node is attached to a device or is otherwise being used. Arguments: 'node-name: string' Name of the graph node to delete. Since: 2.9 Example: -> { "execute": "blockdev-add", "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2", "node-name": "node0", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "test.qcow2" } } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "blockdev-del", "arguments": { "node-name": "node0" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsFile Driver specific image creation options for file. 'filename' Filename for the new image file 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes 'preallocation' Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, falloc (if defined CONFIG_POSIX_FALLOCATE), full (if defined CONFIG_POSIX)) 'nocow' Turn off copy-on-write (valid only on btrfs; default: off) Members: 'filename: string' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented 'preallocation: PreallocMode' (optional) Not documented 'nocow: boolean' (optional) Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsGluster Driver specific image creation options for gluster. 'location' Where to store the new image file 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes 'preallocation' Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, falloc (if defined CONFIG_GLUSTERFS_FALLOCATE), full (if defined CONFIG_GLUSTERFS_ZEROFILL)) Members: 'location: BlockdevOptionsGluster' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented 'preallocation: PreallocMode' (optional) Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsLUKS Driver specific image creation options for LUKS. 'file' Node to create the image format on 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes Members: 'file: BlockdevRef' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented The members of 'QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS' Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsNfs Driver specific image creation options for NFS. 'location' Where to store the new image file 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes Members: 'location: BlockdevOptionsNfs' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsParallels Driver specific image creation options for parallels. 'file' Node to create the image format on 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes 'cluster-size' Cluster size in bytes (default: 1 MB) Members: 'file: BlockdevRef' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented 'cluster-size: int' (optional) Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow Driver specific image creation options for qcow. 'file' Node to create the image format on 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes 'backing-file' File name of the backing file if a backing file should be used 'encrypt' Encryption options if the image should be encrypted Members: 'file: BlockdevRef' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented 'backing-file: string' (optional) Not documented 'encrypt: QCryptoBlockCreateOptions' (optional) Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Enum: BlockdevQcow2Version Values: 'v2' The original QCOW2 format as introduced in qemu 0.10 (version 2) 'v3' The extended QCOW2 format as introduced in qemu 1.1 (version 3) Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow2 Driver specific image creation options for qcow2. 'file' Node to create the image format on 'data-file' Node to use as an external data file in which all guest data is stored so that only metadata remains in the qcow2 file (since: 4.0) 'data-file-raw' True if the external data file must stay valid as a standalone (read-only) raw image without looking at qcow2 metadata (default: false; since: 4.0) 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes 'version' Compatibility level (default: v3) 'backing-file' File name of the backing file if a backing file should be used 'backing-fmt' Name of the block driver to use for the backing file 'encrypt' Encryption options if the image should be encrypted 'cluster-size' qcow2 cluster size in bytes (default: 65536) 'preallocation' Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, falloc, full, metadata) 'lazy-refcounts' True if refcounts may be updated lazily (default: off) 'refcount-bits' Width of reference counts in bits (default: 16) Members: 'file: BlockdevRef' Not documented 'data-file: BlockdevRef' (optional) Not documented 'data-file-raw: boolean' (optional) Not documented 'size: int' Not documented 'version: BlockdevQcow2Version' (optional) Not documented 'backing-file: string' (optional) Not documented 'backing-fmt: BlockdevDriver' (optional) Not documented 'encrypt: QCryptoBlockCreateOptions' (optional) Not documented 'cluster-size: int' (optional) Not documented 'preallocation: PreallocMode' (optional) Not documented 'lazy-refcounts: boolean' (optional) Not documented 'refcount-bits: int' (optional) Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsQed Driver specific image creation options for qed. 'file' Node to create the image format on 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes 'backing-file' File name of the backing file if a backing file should be used 'backing-fmt' Name of the block driver to use for the backing file 'cluster-size' Cluster size in bytes (default: 65536) 'table-size' L1/L2 table size (in clusters) Members: 'file: BlockdevRef' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented 'backing-file: string' (optional) Not documented 'backing-fmt: BlockdevDriver' (optional) Not documented 'cluster-size: int' (optional) Not documented 'table-size: int' (optional) Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsRbd Driver specific image creation options for rbd/Ceph. 'location' Where to store the new image file. This location cannot point to a snapshot. 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes 'cluster-size' RBD object size Members: 'location: BlockdevOptionsRbd' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented 'cluster-size: int' (optional) Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Enum: BlockdevVmdkSubformat Subformat options for VMDK images Values: 'monolithicSparse' Single file image with sparse cluster allocation 'monolithicFlat' Single flat data image and a descriptor file 'twoGbMaxExtentSparse' Data is split into 2GB (per virtual LBA) sparse extent files, in addition to a descriptor file 'twoGbMaxExtentFlat' Data is split into 2GB (per virtual LBA) flat extent files, in addition to a descriptor file 'streamOptimized' Single file image sparse cluster allocation, optimized for streaming over network. Since: 4.0 -- Enum: BlockdevVmdkAdapterType Adapter type info for VMDK images Values: 'ide' Not documented 'buslogic' Not documented 'lsilogic' Not documented 'legacyESX' Not documented Since: 4.0 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsVmdk Driver specific image creation options for VMDK. 'file' Where to store the new image file. This refers to the image file for monolithcSparse and streamOptimized format, or the descriptor file for other formats. 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes 'extents' Where to store the data extents. Required for monolithcFlat, twoGbMaxExtentSparse and twoGbMaxExtentFlat formats. For monolithicFlat, only one entry is required; for twoGbMaxExtent* formats, the number of entries required is calculated as extent_number = virtual_size / 2GB. Providing more extents than will be used is an error. 'subformat' The subformat of the VMDK image. Default: "monolithicSparse". 'backing-file' The path of backing file. Default: no backing file is used. 'adapter-type' The adapter type used to fill in the descriptor. Default: ide. 'hwversion' Hardware version. The meaningful options are "4" or "6". Default: "4". 'zeroed-grain' Whether to enable zeroed-grain feature for sparse subformats. Default: false. Members: 'file: BlockdevRef' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented 'extents: array of BlockdevRef' (optional) Not documented 'subformat: BlockdevVmdkSubformat' (optional) Not documented 'backing-file: string' (optional) Not documented 'adapter-type: BlockdevVmdkAdapterType' (optional) Not documented 'hwversion: string' (optional) Not documented 'zeroed-grain: boolean' (optional) Not documented Since: 4.0 -- Enum: SheepdogRedundancyType 'full' Create a fully replicated vdi with x copies 'erasure-coded' Create an erasure coded vdi with x data strips and y parity strips Values: 'full' Not documented 'erasure-coded' Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: SheepdogRedundancyFull 'copies' Number of copies to use (between 1 and 31) Members: 'copies: int' Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: SheepdogRedundancyErasureCoded 'data-strips' Number of data strips to use (one of {2,4,8,16}) 'parity-strips' Number of parity strips to use (between 1 and 15) Members: 'data-strips: int' Not documented 'parity-strips: int' Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: SheepdogRedundancy Members: 'type: SheepdogRedundancyType' Not documented The members of 'SheepdogRedundancyFull' when 'type' is "full" The members of 'SheepdogRedundancyErasureCoded' when 'type' is "erasure-coded" Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsSheepdog Driver specific image creation options for Sheepdog. 'location' Where to store the new image file 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes 'backing-file' File name of a base image 'preallocation' Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, full) 'redundancy' Redundancy of the image 'object-size' Object size of the image Members: 'location: BlockdevOptionsSheepdog' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented 'backing-file: string' (optional) Not documented 'preallocation: PreallocMode' (optional) Not documented 'redundancy: SheepdogRedundancy' (optional) Not documented 'object-size: int' (optional) Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsSsh Driver specific image creation options for SSH. 'location' Where to store the new image file 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes Members: 'location: BlockdevOptionsSsh' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsVdi Driver specific image creation options for VDI. 'file' Node to create the image format on 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes 'preallocation' Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, metadata) Members: 'file: BlockdevRef' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented 'preallocation: PreallocMode' (optional) Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Enum: BlockdevVhdxSubformat Values: 'dynamic' Growing image file 'fixed' Preallocated fixed-size image file Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsVhdx Driver specific image creation options for vhdx. 'file' Node to create the image format on 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes 'log-size' Log size in bytes, must be a multiple of 1 MB (default: 1 MB) 'block-size' Block size in bytes, must be a multiple of 1 MB and not larger than 256 MB (default: automatically choose a block size depending on the image size) 'subformat' vhdx subformat (default: dynamic) 'block-state-zero' Force use of payload blocks of type 'ZERO'. Non-standard, but default. Do not set to 'off' when using 'qemu-img convert' with subformat=dynamic. Members: 'file: BlockdevRef' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented 'log-size: int' (optional) Not documented 'block-size: int' (optional) Not documented 'subformat: BlockdevVhdxSubformat' (optional) Not documented 'block-state-zero: boolean' (optional) Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Enum: BlockdevVpcSubformat Values: 'dynamic' Growing image file 'fixed' Preallocated fixed-size image file Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptionsVpc Driver specific image creation options for vpc (VHD). 'file' Node to create the image format on 'size' Size of the virtual disk in bytes 'subformat' vhdx subformat (default: dynamic) 'force-size' Force use of the exact byte size instead of rounding to the next size that can be represented in CHS geometry (default: false) Members: 'file: BlockdevRef' Not documented 'size: int' Not documented 'subformat: BlockdevVpcSubformat' (optional) Not documented 'force-size: boolean' (optional) Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: BlockdevCreateOptions Options for creating an image format on a given node. 'driver' block driver to create the image format Members: 'driver: BlockdevDriver' Not documented The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsFile' when 'driver' is "file" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsGluster' when 'driver' is "gluster" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsLUKS' when 'driver' is "luks" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsNfs' when 'driver' is "nfs" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsParallels' when 'driver' is "parallels" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow' when 'driver' is "qcow" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow2' when 'driver' is "qcow2" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsQed' when 'driver' is "qed" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsRbd' when 'driver' is "rbd" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsSheepdog' when 'driver' is "sheepdog" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsSsh' when 'driver' is "ssh" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsVdi' when 'driver' is "vdi" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsVhdx' when 'driver' is "vhdx" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsVmdk' when 'driver' is "vmdk" The members of 'BlockdevCreateOptionsVpc' when 'driver' is "vpc" Since: 2.12 -- Command: blockdev-create Starts a job to create an image format on a given node. The job is automatically finalized, but a manual job-dismiss is required. Arguments: 'job-id: string' Identifier for the newly created job. 'options: BlockdevCreateOptions' Options for the image creation. Since: 3.0 -- Command: blockdev-open-tray Opens a block device's tray. If there is a block driver state tree inserted as a medium, it will become inaccessible to the guest (but it will remain associated to the block device, so closing the tray will make it accessible again). If the tray was already open before, this will be a no-op. Once the tray opens, a DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED event is emitted. There are cases in which no such event will be generated, these include: - if the guest has locked the tray, 'force' is false and the guest does not respond to the eject request - if the BlockBackend denoted by 'device' does not have a guest device attached to it - if the guest device does not have an actual tray Arguments: 'device: string' (optional) Block device name (deprecated, use 'id' instead) 'id: string' (optional) The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8) 'force: boolean' (optional) if false (the default), an eject request will be sent to the guest if it has locked the tray (and the tray will not be opened immediately); if true, the tray will be opened regardless of whether it is locked Since: 2.5 Example: -> { "execute": "blockdev-open-tray", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } } <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751016, "microseconds": 716996 }, "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED", "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0", "id": "ide0-1-0", "tray-open": true } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: blockdev-close-tray Closes a block device's tray. If there is a block driver state tree associated with the block device (which is currently ejected), that tree will be loaded as the medium. If the tray was already closed before, this will be a no-op. Arguments: 'device: string' (optional) Block device name (deprecated, use 'id' instead) 'id: string' (optional) The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8) Since: 2.5 Example: -> { "execute": "blockdev-close-tray", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } } <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751345, "microseconds": 272147 }, "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED", "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0", "id": "ide0-1-0", "tray-open": false } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: blockdev-remove-medium Removes a medium (a block driver state tree) from a block device. That block device's tray must currently be open (unless there is no attached guest device). If the tray is open and there is no medium inserted, this will be a no-op. Arguments: 'id: string' The name or QOM path of the guest device Since: 2.12 Example: -> { "execute": "blockdev-remove-medium", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } } <- { "error": { "class": "GenericError", "desc": "Tray of device 'ide0-1-0' is not open" } } -> { "execute": "blockdev-open-tray", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } } <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751627, "microseconds": 549958 }, "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED", "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0", "id": "ide0-1-0", "tray-open": true } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "blockdev-remove-medium", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: blockdev-insert-medium Inserts a medium (a block driver state tree) into a block device. That block device's tray must currently be open (unless there is no attached guest device) and there must be no medium inserted already. Arguments: 'id: string' The name or QOM path of the guest device 'node-name: string' name of a node in the block driver state graph Since: 2.12 Example: -> { "execute": "blockdev-add", "arguments": { "node-name": "node0", "driver": "raw", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "fedora.iso" } } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "blockdev-insert-medium", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0", "node-name": "node0" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Enum: BlockdevChangeReadOnlyMode Specifies the new read-only mode of a block device subject to the 'blockdev-change-medium' command. Values: 'retain' Retains the current read-only mode 'read-only' Makes the device read-only 'read-write' Makes the device writable Since: 2.3 -- Command: blockdev-change-medium Changes the medium inserted into a block device by ejecting the current medium and loading a new image file which is inserted as the new medium (this command combines blockdev-open-tray, blockdev-remove-medium, blockdev-insert-medium and blockdev-close-tray). Arguments: 'device: string' (optional) Block device name (deprecated, use 'id' instead) 'id: string' (optional) The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8) 'filename: string' filename of the new image to be loaded 'format: string' (optional) format to open the new image with (defaults to the probed format) 'read-only-mode: BlockdevChangeReadOnlyMode' (optional) change the read-only mode of the device; defaults to 'retain' Since: 2.5 Examples: 1. Change a removable medium -> { "execute": "blockdev-change-medium", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0", "filename": "/srv/images/Fedora-12-x86_64-DVD.iso", "format": "raw" } } <- { "return": {} } 2. Load a read-only medium into a writable drive -> { "execute": "blockdev-change-medium", "arguments": { "id": "floppyA", "filename": "/srv/images/ro.img", "format": "raw", "read-only-mode": "retain" } } <- { "error": { "class": "GenericError", "desc": "Could not open '/srv/images/ro.img': Permission denied" } } -> { "execute": "blockdev-change-medium", "arguments": { "id": "floppyA", "filename": "/srv/images/ro.img", "format": "raw", "read-only-mode": "read-only" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Enum: BlockErrorAction An enumeration of action that has been taken when a DISK I/O occurs Values: 'ignore' error has been ignored 'report' error has been reported to the device 'stop' error caused VM to be stopped Since: 2.1 -- Event: BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED Emitted when a disk image is being marked corrupt. The image can be identified by its device or node name. The 'device' field is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated. Arguments: 'device: string' device name. This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated. 'node-name: string' (optional) node name (Since: 2.4) 'msg: string' informative message for human consumption, such as the kind of corruption being detected. It should not be parsed by machine as it is not guaranteed to be stable 'offset: int' (optional) if the corruption resulted from an image access, this is the host's access offset into the image 'size: int' (optional) if the corruption resulted from an image access, this is the access size 'fatal: boolean' if set, the image is marked corrupt and therefore unusable after this event and must be repaired (Since 2.2; before, every BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED event was fatal) Note: If action is "stop", a STOP event will eventually follow the BLOCK_IO_ERROR event. Example: <- { "event": "BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED", "data": { "device": "ide0-hd0", "node-name": "node0", "msg": "Prevented active L1 table overwrite", "offset": 196608, "size": 65536 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1378126126, "microseconds": 966463 } } Since: 1.7 -- Event: BLOCK_IO_ERROR Emitted when a disk I/O error occurs Arguments: 'device: string' device name. This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated. 'node-name: string' (optional) node name. Note that errors may be reported for the root node that is directly attached to a guest device rather than for the node where the error occurred. The node name is not present if the drive is empty. (Since: 2.8) 'operation: IoOperationType' I/O operation 'action: BlockErrorAction' action that has been taken 'nospace: boolean' (optional) true if I/O error was caused due to a no-space condition. This key is only present if query-block's io-status is present, please see query-block documentation for more information (since: 2.2) 'reason: string' human readable string describing the error cause. (This field is a debugging aid for humans, it should not be parsed by applications) (since: 2.2) Note: If action is "stop", a STOP event will eventually follow the BLOCK_IO_ERROR event Since: 0.13.0 Example: <- { "event": "BLOCK_IO_ERROR", "data": { "device": "ide0-hd1", "node-name": "#block212", "operation": "write", "action": "stop" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } -- Event: BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED Emitted when a block job has completed Arguments: 'type: JobType' job type 'device: string' The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7 'len: int' maximum progress value 'offset: int' current progress value. On success this is equal to len. On failure this is less than len 'speed: int' rate limit, bytes per second 'error: string' (optional) error message. Only present on failure. This field contains a human-readable error message. There are no semantics other than that streaming has failed and clients should not try to interpret the error string Since: 1.1 Example: <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED", "data": { "type": "stream", "device": "virtio-disk0", "len": 10737418240, "offset": 10737418240, "speed": 0 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } } -- Event: BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED Emitted when a block job has been cancelled Arguments: 'type: JobType' job type 'device: string' The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7 'len: int' maximum progress value 'offset: int' current progress value. On success this is equal to len. On failure this is less than len 'speed: int' rate limit, bytes per second Since: 1.1 Example: <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED", "data": { "type": "stream", "device": "virtio-disk0", "len": 10737418240, "offset": 134217728, "speed": 0 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } } -- Event: BLOCK_JOB_ERROR Emitted when a block job encounters an error Arguments: 'device: string' The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7 'operation: IoOperationType' I/O operation 'action: BlockErrorAction' action that has been taken Since: 1.3 Example: <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_ERROR", "data": { "device": "ide0-hd1", "operation": "write", "action": "stop" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } -- Event: BLOCK_JOB_READY Emitted when a block job is ready to complete Arguments: 'type: JobType' job type 'device: string' The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7 'len: int' maximum progress value 'offset: int' current progress value. On success this is equal to len. On failure this is less than len 'speed: int' rate limit, bytes per second Note: The "ready to complete" status is always reset by a 'BLOCK_JOB_ERROR' event Since: 1.3 Example: <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_READY", "data": { "device": "drive0", "type": "mirror", "speed": 0, "len": 2097152, "offset": 2097152 } "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } -- Event: BLOCK_JOB_PENDING Emitted when a block job is awaiting explicit authorization to finalize graph changes via 'block-job-finalize'. If this job is part of a transaction, it will not emit this event until the transaction has converged first. Arguments: 'type: JobType' job type 'id: string' The job identifier. Since: 2.12 Example: <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_WAITING", "data": { "device": "drive0", "type": "mirror" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } -- Enum: PreallocMode Preallocation mode of QEMU image file Values: 'off' no preallocation 'metadata' preallocate only for metadata 'falloc' like 'full' preallocation but allocate disk space by posix_fallocate() rather than writing zeros. 'full' preallocate all data by writing zeros to device to ensure disk space is really available. 'full' preallocation also sets up metadata correctly. Since: 2.2 -- Event: BLOCK_WRITE_THRESHOLD Emitted when writes on block device reaches or exceeds the configured write threshold. For thin-provisioned devices, this means the device should be extended to avoid pausing for disk exhaustion. The event is one shot. Once triggered, it needs to be re-registered with another block-set-write-threshold command. Arguments: 'node-name: string' graph node name on which the threshold was exceeded. 'amount-exceeded: int' amount of data which exceeded the threshold, in bytes. 'write-threshold: int' last configured threshold, in bytes. Since: 2.3 -- Command: block-set-write-threshold Change the write threshold for a block drive. An event will be delivered if a write to this block drive crosses the configured threshold. The threshold is an offset, thus must be non-negative. Default is no write threshold. Setting the threshold to zero disables it. This is useful to transparently resize thin-provisioned drives without the guest OS noticing. Arguments: 'node-name: string' graph node name on which the threshold must be set. 'write-threshold: int' configured threshold for the block device, bytes. Use 0 to disable the threshold. Since: 2.3 Example: -> { "execute": "block-set-write-threshold", "arguments": { "node-name": "mydev", "write-threshold": 17179869184 } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: x-blockdev-change Dynamically reconfigure the block driver state graph. It can be used to add, remove, insert or replace a graph node. Currently only the Quorum driver implements this feature to add or remove its child. This is useful to fix a broken quorum child. If 'node' is specified, it will be inserted under 'parent'. 'child' may not be specified in this case. If both 'parent' and 'child' are specified but 'node' is not, 'child' will be detached from 'parent'. Arguments: 'parent: string' the id or name of the parent node. 'child: string' (optional) the name of a child under the given parent node. 'node: string' (optional) the name of the node that will be added. Note: this command is experimental, and its API is not stable. It does not support all kinds of operations, all kinds of children, nor all block drivers. FIXME Removing children from a quorum node means introducing gaps in the child indices. This cannot be represented in the 'children' list of BlockdevOptionsQuorum, as returned by .bdrv_refresh_filename(). Warning: The data in a new quorum child MUST be consistent with that of the rest of the array. Since: 2.7 Example: 1. Add a new node to a quorum -> { "execute": "blockdev-add", "arguments": { "driver": "raw", "node-name": "new_node", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "test.raw" } } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-change", "arguments": { "parent": "disk1", "node": "new_node" } } <- { "return": {} } 2. Delete a quorum's node -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-change", "arguments": { "parent": "disk1", "child": "children.1" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: x-blockdev-set-iothread Move 'node' and its children into the 'iothread'. If 'iothread' is null then move 'node' and its children into the main loop. The node must not be attached to a BlockBackend. Arguments: 'node-name: string' the name of the block driver node 'iothread: StrOrNull' the name of the IOThread object or null for the main loop 'force: boolean' (optional) true if the node and its children should be moved when a BlockBackend is already attached Note: this command is experimental and intended for test cases that need control over IOThreads only. Since: 2.12 Example: 1. Move a node into an IOThread -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-set-iothread", "arguments": { "node-name": "disk1", "iothread": "iothread0" } } <- { "return": {} } 2. Move a node into the main loop -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-set-iothread", "arguments": { "node-name": "disk1", "iothread": null } } <- { "return": {} } 1.7.3 Additional block stuff (VM related) ----------------------------------------- -- Enum: BiosAtaTranslation Policy that BIOS should use to interpret cylinder/head/sector addresses. Note that Bochs BIOS and SeaBIOS will not actually translate logical CHS to physical; instead, they will use logical block addressing. Values: 'auto' If cylinder/heads/sizes are passed, choose between none and LBA depending on the size of the disk. If they are not passed, choose none if QEMU can guess that the disk had 16 or fewer heads, large if QEMU can guess that the disk had 131072 or fewer tracks across all heads (i.e. cylinders*heads<131072), otherwise LBA. 'none' The physical disk geometry is equal to the logical geometry. 'lba' Assume 63 sectors per track and one of 16, 32, 64, 128 or 255 heads (if fewer than 255 are enough to cover the whole disk with 1024 cylinders/head). The number of cylinders/head is then computed based on the number of sectors and heads. 'large' The number of cylinders per head is scaled down to 1024 by correspondingly scaling up the number of heads. 'rechs' Same as 'large', but first convert a 16-head geometry to 15-head, by proportionally scaling up the number of cylinders/head. Since: 2.0 -- Enum: FloppyDriveType Type of Floppy drive to be emulated by the Floppy Disk Controller. Values: '144' 1.44MB 3.5" drive '288' 2.88MB 3.5" drive '120' 1.2MB 5.25" drive 'none' No drive connected 'auto' Automatically determined by inserted media at boot Since: 2.6 -- Object: BlockdevSnapshotInternal Members: 'device: string' the device name or node-name of a root node to generate the snapshot from 'name: string' the name of the internal snapshot to be created Notes: In transaction, if 'name' is empty, or any snapshot matching 'name' exists, the operation will fail. Only some image formats support it, for example, qcow2, rbd, and sheepdog. Since: 1.7 -- Object: PRManagerInfo Information about a persistent reservation manager Members: 'id: string' the identifier of the persistent reservation manager 'connected: boolean' true if the persistent reservation manager is connected to the underlying storage or helper Since: 3.0 -- Command: query-pr-managers Returns a list of information about each persistent reservation manager. Returns: a list of 'PRManagerInfo' for each persistent reservation manager Since: 3.0 -- Command: blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync Synchronously take an internal snapshot of a block device, when the format of the image used supports it. If the name is an empty string, or a snapshot with name already exists, the operation will fail. For the arguments, see the documentation of BlockdevSnapshotInternal. Returns: nothing on success If 'device' is not a valid block device, GenericError If any snapshot matching 'name' exists, or 'name' is empty, GenericError If the format of the image used does not support it, BlockFormatFeatureNotSupported Since: 1.7 Example: -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync", "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0", "name": "snapshot0" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: blockdev-snapshot-delete-internal-sync Synchronously delete an internal snapshot of a block device, when the format of the image used support it. The snapshot is identified by name or id or both. One of the name or id is required. Return SnapshotInfo for the successfully deleted snapshot. Arguments: 'device: string' the device name or node-name of a root node to delete the snapshot from 'id: string' (optional) optional the snapshot's ID to be deleted 'name: string' (optional) optional the snapshot's name to be deleted Returns: SnapshotInfo on success If 'device' is not a valid block device, GenericError If snapshot not found, GenericError If the format of the image used does not support it, BlockFormatFeatureNotSupported If 'id' and 'name' are both not specified, GenericError Since: 1.7 Example: -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot-delete-internal-sync", "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0", "name": "snapshot0" } } <- { "return": { "id": "1", "name": "snapshot0", "vm-state-size": 0, "date-sec": 1000012, "date-nsec": 10, "vm-clock-sec": 100, "vm-clock-nsec": 20 } } -- Command: eject Ejects a device from a removable drive. Arguments: 'device: string' (optional) Block device name (deprecated, use 'id' instead) 'id: string' (optional) The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8) 'force: boolean' (optional) If true, eject regardless of whether the drive is locked. If not specified, the default value is false. Returns: Nothing on success If 'device' is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound Notes: Ejecting a device with no media results in success Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "eject", "arguments": { "id": "ide1-0-1" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: nbd-server-start Start an NBD server listening on the given host and port. Block devices can then be exported using 'nbd-server-add'. The NBD server will present them as named exports; for example, another QEMU instance could refer to them as "nbd:HOST:PORT:exportname=NAME". Arguments: 'addr: SocketAddressLegacy' Address on which to listen. 'tls-creds: string' (optional) ID of the TLS credentials object (since 2.6). 'tls-authz: string' (optional) ID of the QAuthZ authorization object used to validate the client's x509 distinguished name. This object is is only resolved at time of use, so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the NBD server is active. If missing, it will default to denying access (since 4.0). Returns: error if the server is already running. Since: 1.3.0 -- Command: nbd-server-add Export a block node to QEMU's embedded NBD server. Arguments: 'device: string' The device name or node name of the node to be exported 'name: string' (optional) Export name. If unspecified, the 'device' parameter is used as the export name. (Since 2.12) 'writable: boolean' (optional) Whether clients should be able to write to the device via the NBD connection (default false). 'bitmap: string' (optional) Also export the dirty bitmap reachable from 'device', so the NBD client can use NBD_OPT_SET_META_CONTEXT with "qemu:dirty-bitmap:NAME" to inspect the bitmap. (since 4.0) Returns: error if the server is not running, or export with the same name already exists. Since: 1.3.0 -- Enum: NbdServerRemoveMode Mode for removing an NBD export. Values: 'safe' Remove export if there are no existing connections, fail otherwise. 'hard' Drop all connections immediately and remove export. Potential additional modes to be added in the future: hide: Just hide export from new clients, leave existing connections as is. Remove export after all clients are disconnected. soft: Hide export from new clients, answer with ESHUTDOWN for all further requests from existing clients. Since: 2.12 -- Command: nbd-server-remove Remove NBD export by name. Arguments: 'name: string' Export name. 'mode: NbdServerRemoveMode' (optional) Mode of command operation. See 'NbdServerRemoveMode' description. Default is 'safe'. Returns: error if - the server is not running - export is not found - mode is 'safe' and there are existing connections Since: 2.12 -- Command: nbd-server-stop Stop QEMU's embedded NBD server, and unregister all devices previously added via 'nbd-server-add'. Since: 1.3.0 -- Event: DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED Emitted whenever the tray of a removable device is moved by the guest or by HMP/QMP commands Arguments: 'device: string' Block device name. This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated. 'id: string' The name or QOM path of the guest device (since 2.8) 'tray-open: boolean' true if the tray has been opened or false if it has been closed Since: 1.1 Example: <- { "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED", "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0", "id": "/machine/unattached/device[22]", "tray-open": true }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } -- Event: PR_MANAGER_STATUS_CHANGED Emitted whenever the connected status of a persistent reservation manager changes. Arguments: 'id: string' The id of the PR manager object 'connected: boolean' true if the PR manager is connected to a backend Since: 3.0 Example: <- { "event": "PR_MANAGER_STATUS_CHANGED", "data": { "id": "pr-helper0", "connected": true }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1519840375, "microseconds": 450486 } } -- Enum: QuorumOpType An enumeration of the quorum operation types Values: 'read' read operation 'write' write operation 'flush' flush operation Since: 2.6 -- Event: QUORUM_FAILURE Emitted by the Quorum block driver if it fails to establish a quorum Arguments: 'reference: string' device name if defined else node name 'sector-num: int' number of the first sector of the failed read operation 'sectors-count: int' failed read operation sector count Note: This event is rate-limited. Since: 2.0 Example: <- { "event": "QUORUM_FAILURE", "data": { "reference": "usr1", "sector-num": 345435, "sectors-count": 5 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } } -- Event: QUORUM_REPORT_BAD Emitted to report a corruption of a Quorum file Arguments: 'type: QuorumOpType' quorum operation type (Since 2.6) 'error: string' (optional) error message. Only present on failure. This field contains a human-readable error message. There are no semantics other than that the block layer reported an error and clients should not try to interpret the error string. 'node-name: string' the graph node name of the block driver state 'sector-num: int' number of the first sector of the failed read operation 'sectors-count: int' failed read operation sector count Note: This event is rate-limited. Since: 2.0 Example: 1. Read operation { "event": "QUORUM_REPORT_BAD", "data": { "node-name": "node0", "sector-num": 345435, "sectors-count": 5, "type": "read" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } } 2. Flush operation { "event": "QUORUM_REPORT_BAD", "data": { "node-name": "node0", "sector-num": 0, "sectors-count": 2097120, "type": "flush", "error": "Broken pipe" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1456406829, "microseconds": 291763 } } 1.8 Character devices ===================== -- Object: ChardevInfo Information about a character device. Members: 'label: string' the label of the character device 'filename: string' the filename of the character device 'frontend-open: boolean' shows whether the frontend device attached to this backend (eg. with the chardev=... option) is in open or closed state (since 2.1) Notes: 'filename' is encoded using the QEMU command line character device encoding. See the QEMU man page for details. Since: 0.14.0 -- Command: query-chardev Returns information about current character devices. Returns: a list of 'ChardevInfo' Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-chardev" } <- { "return": [ { "label": "charchannel0", "filename": "unix:/var/lib/libvirt/qemu/seabios.rhel6.agent,server", "frontend-open": false }, { "label": "charmonitor", "filename": "unix:/var/lib/libvirt/qemu/seabios.rhel6.monitor,server", "frontend-open": true }, { "label": "charserial0", "filename": "pty:/dev/pts/2", "frontend-open": true } ] } -- Object: ChardevBackendInfo Information about a character device backend Members: 'name: string' The backend name Since: 2.0 -- Command: query-chardev-backends Returns information about character device backends. Returns: a list of 'ChardevBackendInfo' Since: 2.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-chardev-backends" } <- { "return":[ { "name":"udp" }, { "name":"tcp" }, { "name":"unix" }, { "name":"spiceport" } ] } -- Enum: DataFormat An enumeration of data format. Values: 'utf8' Data is a UTF-8 string (RFC 3629) 'base64' Data is Base64 encoded binary (RFC 3548) Since: 1.4 -- Command: ringbuf-write Write to a ring buffer character device. Arguments: 'device: string' the ring buffer character device name 'data: string' data to write 'format: DataFormat' (optional) data encoding (default 'utf8'). - base64: data must be base64 encoded text. Its binary decoding gets written. - utf8: data's UTF-8 encoding is written - data itself is always Unicode regardless of format, like any other string. Returns: Nothing on success Since: 1.4 Example: -> { "execute": "ringbuf-write", "arguments": { "device": "foo", "data": "abcdefgh", "format": "utf8" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: ringbuf-read Read from a ring buffer character device. Arguments: 'device: string' the ring buffer character device name 'size: int' how many bytes to read at most 'format: DataFormat' (optional) data encoding (default 'utf8'). - base64: the data read is returned in base64 encoding. - utf8: the data read is interpreted as UTF-8. Bug: can screw up when the buffer contains invalid UTF-8 sequences, NUL characters, after the ring buffer lost data, and when reading stops because the size limit is reached. - The return value is always Unicode regardless of format, like any other string. Returns: data read from the device Since: 1.4 Example: -> { "execute": "ringbuf-read", "arguments": { "device": "foo", "size": 1000, "format": "utf8" } } <- { "return": "abcdefgh" } -- Object: ChardevCommon Configuration shared across all chardev backends Members: 'logfile: string' (optional) The name of a logfile to save output 'logappend: boolean' (optional) true to append instead of truncate (default to false to truncate) Since: 2.6 -- Object: ChardevFile Configuration info for file chardevs. Members: 'in: string' (optional) The name of the input file 'out: string' The name of the output file 'append: boolean' (optional) Open the file in append mode (default false to truncate) (Since 2.6) The members of 'ChardevCommon' Since: 1.4 -- Object: ChardevHostdev Configuration info for device and pipe chardevs. Members: 'device: string' The name of the special file for the device, i.e. /dev/ttyS0 on Unix or COM1: on Windows The members of 'ChardevCommon' Since: 1.4 -- Object: ChardevSocket Configuration info for (stream) socket chardevs. Members: 'addr: SocketAddressLegacy' socket address to listen on (server=true) or connect to (server=false) 'tls-creds: string' (optional) the ID of the TLS credentials object (since 2.6) 'tls-authz: string' (optional) the ID of the QAuthZ authorization object against which the client's x509 distinguished name will be validated. This object is only resolved at time of use, so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the chardev server is active. If missing, it will default to denying access (since 4.0) 'server: boolean' (optional) create server socket (default: true) 'wait: boolean' (optional) wait for incoming connection on server sockets (default: false). 'nodelay: boolean' (optional) set TCP_NODELAY socket option (default: false) 'telnet: boolean' (optional) enable telnet protocol on server sockets (default: false) 'tn3270: boolean' (optional) enable tn3270 protocol on server sockets (default: false) (Since: 2.10) 'websocket: boolean' (optional) enable websocket protocol on server sockets (default: false) (Since: 3.1) 'reconnect: int' (optional) For a client socket, if a socket is disconnected, then attempt a reconnect after the given number of seconds. Setting this to zero disables this function. (default: 0) (Since: 2.2) The members of 'ChardevCommon' Since: 1.4 -- Object: ChardevUdp Configuration info for datagram socket chardevs. Members: 'remote: SocketAddressLegacy' remote address 'local: SocketAddressLegacy' (optional) local address The members of 'ChardevCommon' Since: 1.5 -- Object: ChardevMux Configuration info for mux chardevs. Members: 'chardev: string' name of the base chardev. The members of 'ChardevCommon' Since: 1.5 -- Object: ChardevStdio Configuration info for stdio chardevs. Members: 'signal: boolean' (optional) Allow signals (such as SIGINT triggered by ^C) be delivered to qemu. Default: true in -nographic mode, false otherwise. The members of 'ChardevCommon' Since: 1.5 -- Object: ChardevSpiceChannel Configuration info for spice vm channel chardevs. Members: 'type: string' kind of channel (for example vdagent). The members of 'ChardevCommon' Since: 1.5 If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)' -- Object: ChardevSpicePort Configuration info for spice port chardevs. Members: 'fqdn: string' name of the channel (see docs/spice-port-fqdn.txt) The members of 'ChardevCommon' Since: 1.5 If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)' -- Object: ChardevVC Configuration info for virtual console chardevs. Members: 'width: int' (optional) console width, in pixels 'height: int' (optional) console height, in pixels 'cols: int' (optional) console width, in chars 'rows: int' (optional) console height, in chars The members of 'ChardevCommon' Since: 1.5 -- Object: ChardevRingbuf Configuration info for ring buffer chardevs. Members: 'size: int' (optional) ring buffer size, must be power of two, default is 65536 The members of 'ChardevCommon' Since: 1.5 -- Object: ChardevBackend Configuration info for the new chardev backend. Members: 'type' One of "file", "serial", "parallel", "pipe", "socket", "udp", "pty", "null", "mux", "msmouse", "wctablet", "braille", "testdev", "stdio", "console", "spicevmc", "spiceport", "vc", "ringbuf", "memory" 'data: ChardevFile' when 'type' is "file" 'data: ChardevHostdev' when 'type' is "serial" 'data: ChardevHostdev' when 'type' is "parallel" 'data: ChardevHostdev' when 'type' is "pipe" 'data: ChardevSocket' when 'type' is "socket" 'data: ChardevUdp' when 'type' is "udp" 'data: ChardevCommon' when 'type' is "pty" 'data: ChardevCommon' when 'type' is "null" 'data: ChardevMux' when 'type' is "mux" 'data: ChardevCommon' when 'type' is "msmouse" 'data: ChardevCommon' when 'type' is "wctablet" 'data: ChardevCommon' when 'type' is "braille" 'data: ChardevCommon' when 'type' is "testdev" 'data: ChardevStdio' when 'type' is "stdio" 'data: ChardevCommon' when 'type' is "console" 'data: ChardevSpiceChannel' when 'type' is "spicevmc" (If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)') 'data: ChardevSpicePort' when 'type' is "spiceport" (If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)') 'data: ChardevVC' when 'type' is "vc" 'data: ChardevRingbuf' when 'type' is "ringbuf" 'data: ChardevRingbuf' when 'type' is "memory" Since: 1.4 (testdev since 2.2, wctablet since 2.9) -- Object: ChardevReturn Return info about the chardev backend just created. Members: 'pty: string' (optional) name of the slave pseudoterminal device, present if and only if a chardev of type 'pty' was created Since: 1.4 -- Command: chardev-add Add a character device backend Arguments: 'id: string' the chardev's ID, must be unique 'backend: ChardevBackend' backend type and parameters Returns: ChardevReturn. Since: 1.4 Example: -> { "execute" : "chardev-add", "arguments" : { "id" : "foo", "backend" : { "type" : "null", "data" : {} } } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute" : "chardev-add", "arguments" : { "id" : "bar", "backend" : { "type" : "file", "data" : { "out" : "/tmp/bar.log" } } } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute" : "chardev-add", "arguments" : { "id" : "baz", "backend" : { "type" : "pty", "data" : {} } } } <- { "return": { "pty" : "/dev/pty/42" } } -- Command: chardev-change Change a character device backend Arguments: 'id: string' the chardev's ID, must exist 'backend: ChardevBackend' new backend type and parameters Returns: ChardevReturn. Since: 2.10 Example: -> { "execute" : "chardev-change", "arguments" : { "id" : "baz", "backend" : { "type" : "pty", "data" : {} } } } <- { "return": { "pty" : "/dev/pty/42" } } -> {"execute" : "chardev-change", "arguments" : { "id" : "charchannel2", "backend" : { "type" : "socket", "data" : { "addr" : { "type" : "unix" , "data" : { "path" : "/tmp/charchannel2.socket" } }, "server" : true, "wait" : false }}}} <- {"return": {}} -- Command: chardev-remove Remove a character device backend Arguments: 'id: string' the chardev's ID, must exist and not be in use Returns: Nothing on success Since: 1.4 Example: -> { "execute": "chardev-remove", "arguments": { "id" : "foo" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: chardev-send-break Send a break to a character device Arguments: 'id: string' the chardev's ID, must exist Returns: Nothing on success Since: 2.10 Example: -> { "execute": "chardev-send-break", "arguments": { "id" : "foo" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Event: VSERPORT_CHANGE Emitted when the guest opens or closes a virtio-serial port. Arguments: 'id: string' device identifier of the virtio-serial port 'open: boolean' true if the guest has opened the virtio-serial port Since: 2.1 Example: <- { "event": "VSERPORT_CHANGE", "data": { "id": "channel0", "open": true }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1401385907, "microseconds": 422329 } } 1.9 Dump guest memory ===================== -- Enum: DumpGuestMemoryFormat An enumeration of guest-memory-dump's format. Values: 'elf' elf format 'kdump-zlib' kdump-compressed format with zlib-compressed 'kdump-lzo' kdump-compressed format with lzo-compressed 'kdump-snappy' kdump-compressed format with snappy-compressed 'win-dmp' Windows full crashdump format, can be used instead of ELF converting (since 2.13) Since: 2.0 -- Command: dump-guest-memory Dump guest's memory to vmcore. It is a synchronous operation that can take very long depending on the amount of guest memory. Arguments: 'paging: boolean' if true, do paging to get guest's memory mapping. This allows using gdb to process the core file. IMPORTANT: this option can make QEMU allocate several gigabytes of RAM. This can happen for a large guest, or a malicious guest pretending to be large. Also, paging=true has the following limitations: 1. The guest may be in a catastrophic state or can have corrupted memory, which cannot be trusted 2. The guest can be in real-mode even if paging is enabled. For example, the guest uses ACPI to sleep, and ACPI sleep state goes in real-mode 3. Currently only supported on i386 and x86_64. 'protocol: string' the filename or file descriptor of the vmcore. The supported protocols are: 1. file: the protocol starts with "file:", and the following string is the file's path. 2. fd: the protocol starts with "fd:", and the following string is the fd's name. 'detach: boolean' (optional) if true, QMP will return immediately rather than waiting for the dump to finish. The user can track progress using "query-dump". (since 2.6). 'begin: int' (optional) if specified, the starting physical address. 'length: int' (optional) if specified, the memory size, in bytes. If you don't want to dump all guest's memory, please specify the start 'begin' and 'length' 'format: DumpGuestMemoryFormat' (optional) if specified, the format of guest memory dump. But non-elf format is conflict with paging and filter, ie. 'paging', 'begin' and 'length' is not allowed to be specified with non-elf 'format' at the same time (since 2.0) Note: All boolean arguments default to false Returns: nothing on success Since: 1.2 Example: -> { "execute": "dump-guest-memory", "arguments": { "protocol": "fd:dump" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Enum: DumpStatus Describe the status of a long-running background guest memory dump. Values: 'none' no dump-guest-memory has started yet. 'active' there is one dump running in background. 'completed' the last dump has finished successfully. 'failed' the last dump has failed. Since: 2.6 -- Object: DumpQueryResult The result format for 'query-dump'. Members: 'status: DumpStatus' enum of 'DumpStatus', which shows current dump status 'completed: int' bytes written in latest dump (uncompressed) 'total: int' total bytes to be written in latest dump (uncompressed) Since: 2.6 -- Command: query-dump Query latest dump status. Returns: A 'DumpStatus' object showing the dump status. Since: 2.6 Example: -> { "execute": "query-dump" } <- { "return": { "status": "active", "completed": 1024000, "total": 2048000 } } -- Event: DUMP_COMPLETED Emitted when background dump has completed Arguments: 'result: DumpQueryResult' final dump status 'error: string' (optional) human-readable error string that provides hint on why dump failed. Only presents on failure. The user should not try to interpret the error string. Since: 2.6 Example: { "event": "DUMP_COMPLETED", "data": {"result": {"total": 1090650112, "status": "completed", "completed": 1090650112} } } -- Object: DumpGuestMemoryCapability A list of the available formats for dump-guest-memory Members: 'formats: array of DumpGuestMemoryFormat' Not documented Since: 2.0 -- Command: query-dump-guest-memory-capability Returns the available formats for dump-guest-memory Returns: A 'DumpGuestMemoryCapability' object listing available formats for dump-guest-memory Since: 2.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-dump-guest-memory-capability" } <- { "return": { "formats": ["elf", "kdump-zlib", "kdump-lzo", "kdump-snappy"] } 1.10 Net devices ================ -- Command: set_link Sets the link status of a virtual network adapter. Arguments: 'name: string' the device name of the virtual network adapter 'up: boolean' true to set the link status to be up Returns: Nothing on success If 'name' is not a valid network device, DeviceNotFound Since: 0.14.0 Notes: Not all network adapters support setting link status. This command will succeed even if the network adapter does not support link status notification. Example: -> { "execute": "set_link", "arguments": { "name": "e1000.0", "up": false } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: netdev_add Add a network backend. Arguments: 'type: string' the type of network backend. Possible values are listed in NetClientDriver (excluding 'none' and 'nic') 'id: string' the name of the new network backend Additional arguments depend on the type. TODO: This command effectively bypasses QAPI completely due to its "additional arguments" business. It shouldn't have been added to the schema in this form. It should be qapified properly, or replaced by a properly qapified command. Since: 0.14.0 Returns: Nothing on success If 'type' is not a valid network backend, DeviceNotFound Example: -> { "execute": "netdev_add", "arguments": { "type": "user", "id": "netdev1", "dnssearch": "example.org" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: netdev_del Remove a network backend. Arguments: 'id: string' the name of the network backend to remove Returns: Nothing on success If 'id' is not a valid network backend, DeviceNotFound Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "netdev_del", "arguments": { "id": "netdev1" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Object: NetLegacyNicOptions Create a new Network Interface Card. Members: 'netdev: string' (optional) id of -netdev to connect to 'macaddr: string' (optional) MAC address 'model: string' (optional) device model (e1000, rtl8139, virtio etc.) 'addr: string' (optional) PCI device address 'vectors: int' (optional) number of MSI-x vectors, 0 to disable MSI-X Since: 1.2 -- Object: NetdevUserOptions Use the user mode network stack which requires no administrator privilege to run. Members: 'hostname: string' (optional) client hostname reported by the builtin DHCP server 'restrict: boolean' (optional) isolate the guest from the host 'ipv4: boolean' (optional) whether to support IPv4, default true for enabled (since 2.6) 'ipv6: boolean' (optional) whether to support IPv6, default true for enabled (since 2.6) 'ip: string' (optional) legacy parameter, use net= instead 'net: string' (optional) IP network address that the guest will see, in the form addr[/netmask] The netmask is optional, and can be either in the form a.b.c.d or as a number of valid top-most bits. Default is 10.0.2.0/24. 'host: string' (optional) guest-visible address of the host 'tftp: string' (optional) root directory of the built-in TFTP server 'bootfile: string' (optional) BOOTP filename, for use with tftp= 'dhcpstart: string' (optional) the first of the 16 IPs the built-in DHCP server can assign 'dns: string' (optional) guest-visible address of the virtual nameserver 'dnssearch: array of String' (optional) list of DNS suffixes to search, passed as DHCP option to the guest 'domainname: string' (optional) guest-visible domain name of the virtual nameserver (since 3.0) 'ipv6-prefix: string' (optional) IPv6 network prefix (default is fec0::) (since 2.6). The network prefix is given in the usual hexadecimal IPv6 address notation. 'ipv6-prefixlen: int' (optional) IPv6 network prefix length (default is 64) (since 2.6) 'ipv6-host: string' (optional) guest-visible IPv6 address of the host (since 2.6) 'ipv6-dns: string' (optional) guest-visible IPv6 address of the virtual nameserver (since 2.6) 'smb: string' (optional) root directory of the built-in SMB server 'smbserver: string' (optional) IP address of the built-in SMB server 'hostfwd: array of String' (optional) redirect incoming TCP or UDP host connections to guest endpoints 'guestfwd: array of String' (optional) forward guest TCP connections 'tftp-server-name: string' (optional) RFC2132 "TFTP server name" string (Since 3.1) Since: 1.2 -- Object: NetdevTapOptions Used to configure a host TAP network interface backend. Members: 'ifname: string' (optional) interface name 'fd: string' (optional) file descriptor of an already opened tap 'fds: string' (optional) multiple file descriptors of already opened multiqueue capable tap 'script: string' (optional) script to initialize the interface 'downscript: string' (optional) script to shut down the interface 'br: string' (optional) bridge name (since 2.8) 'helper: string' (optional) command to execute to configure bridge 'sndbuf: int' (optional) send buffer limit. Understands [TGMKkb] suffixes. 'vnet_hdr: boolean' (optional) enable the IFF_VNET_HDR flag on the tap interface 'vhost: boolean' (optional) enable vhost-net network accelerator 'vhostfd: string' (optional) file descriptor of an already opened vhost net device 'vhostfds: string' (optional) file descriptors of multiple already opened vhost net devices 'vhostforce: boolean' (optional) vhost on for non-MSIX virtio guests 'queues: int' (optional) number of queues to be created for multiqueue capable tap 'poll-us: int' (optional) maximum number of microseconds that could be spent on busy polling for tap (since 2.7) Since: 1.2 -- Object: NetdevSocketOptions Socket netdevs are used to establish a network connection to another QEMU virtual machine via a TCP socket. Members: 'fd: string' (optional) file descriptor of an already opened socket 'listen: string' (optional) port number, and optional hostname, to listen on 'connect: string' (optional) port number, and optional hostname, to connect to 'mcast: string' (optional) UDP multicast address and port number 'localaddr: string' (optional) source address and port for multicast and udp packets 'udp: string' (optional) UDP unicast address and port number Since: 1.2 -- Object: NetdevL2TPv3Options Configure an Ethernet over L2TPv3 tunnel. Members: 'src: string' source address 'dst: string' destination address 'srcport: string' (optional) source port - mandatory for udp, optional for ip 'dstport: string' (optional) destination port - mandatory for udp, optional for ip 'ipv6: boolean' (optional) force the use of ipv6 'udp: boolean' (optional) use the udp version of l2tpv3 encapsulation 'cookie64: boolean' (optional) use 64 bit coookies 'counter: boolean' (optional) have sequence counter 'pincounter: boolean' (optional) pin sequence counter to zero - workaround for buggy implementations or networks with packet reorder 'txcookie: int' (optional) 32 or 64 bit transmit cookie 'rxcookie: int' (optional) 32 or 64 bit receive cookie 'txsession: int' 32 bit transmit session 'rxsession: int' (optional) 32 bit receive session - if not specified set to the same value as transmit 'offset: int' (optional) additional offset - allows the insertion of additional application-specific data before the packet payload Since: 2.1 -- Object: NetdevVdeOptions Connect to a vde switch running on the host. Members: 'sock: string' (optional) socket path 'port: int' (optional) port number 'group: string' (optional) group owner of socket 'mode: int' (optional) permissions for socket Since: 1.2 -- Object: NetdevBridgeOptions Connect a host TAP network interface to a host bridge device. Members: 'br: string' (optional) bridge name 'helper: string' (optional) command to execute to configure bridge Since: 1.2 -- Object: NetdevHubPortOptions Connect two or more net clients through a software hub. Members: 'hubid: int' hub identifier number 'netdev: string' (optional) used to connect hub to a netdev instead of a device (since 2.12) Since: 1.2 -- Object: NetdevNetmapOptions Connect a client to a netmap-enabled NIC or to a VALE switch port Members: 'ifname: string' Either the name of an existing network interface supported by netmap, or the name of a VALE port (created on the fly). A VALE port name is in the form 'valeXXX:YYY', where XXX and YYY are non-negative integers. XXX identifies a switch and YYY identifies a port of the switch. VALE ports having the same XXX are therefore connected to the same switch. 'devname: string' (optional) path of the netmap device (default: '/dev/netmap'). Since: 2.0 -- Object: NetdevVhostUserOptions Vhost-user network backend Members: 'chardev: string' name of a unix socket chardev 'vhostforce: boolean' (optional) vhost on for non-MSIX virtio guests (default: false). 'queues: int' (optional) number of queues to be created for multiqueue vhost-user (default: 1) (Since 2.5) Since: 2.1 -- Enum: NetClientDriver Available netdev drivers. Values: 'none' Not documented 'nic' Not documented 'user' Not documented 'tap' Not documented 'l2tpv3' Not documented 'socket' Not documented 'vde' Not documented 'bridge' Not documented 'hubport' Not documented 'netmap' Not documented 'vhost-user' Not documented Since: 2.7 'dump': dropped in 2.12 -- Object: Netdev Captures the configuration of a network device. Members: 'id: string' identifier for monitor commands. 'type: NetClientDriver' Specify the driver used for interpreting remaining arguments. The members of 'NetLegacyNicOptions' when 'type' is "nic" The members of 'NetdevUserOptions' when 'type' is "user" The members of 'NetdevTapOptions' when 'type' is "tap" The members of 'NetdevL2TPv3Options' when 'type' is "l2tpv3" The members of 'NetdevSocketOptions' when 'type' is "socket" The members of 'NetdevVdeOptions' when 'type' is "vde" The members of 'NetdevBridgeOptions' when 'type' is "bridge" The members of 'NetdevHubPortOptions' when 'type' is "hubport" The members of 'NetdevNetmapOptions' when 'type' is "netmap" The members of 'NetdevVhostUserOptions' when 'type' is "vhost-user" Since: 1.2 'l2tpv3' - since 2.1 -- Object: NetLegacy Captures the configuration of a network device; legacy. Members: 'id: string' (optional) identifier for monitor commands 'name: string' (optional) identifier for monitor commands, ignored if 'id' is present 'opts: NetLegacyOptions' device type specific properties (legacy) Since: 1.2 'vlan': dropped in 3.0 -- Enum: NetLegacyOptionsType Values: 'none' Not documented 'nic' Not documented 'user' Not documented 'tap' Not documented 'l2tpv3' Not documented 'socket' Not documented 'vde' Not documented 'bridge' Not documented 'netmap' Not documented 'vhost-user' Not documented Since: 1.2 -- Object: NetLegacyOptions Like Netdev, but for use only by the legacy command line options Members: 'type: NetLegacyOptionsType' Not documented The members of 'NetLegacyNicOptions' when 'type' is "nic" The members of 'NetdevUserOptions' when 'type' is "user" The members of 'NetdevTapOptions' when 'type' is "tap" The members of 'NetdevL2TPv3Options' when 'type' is "l2tpv3" The members of 'NetdevSocketOptions' when 'type' is "socket" The members of 'NetdevVdeOptions' when 'type' is "vde" The members of 'NetdevBridgeOptions' when 'type' is "bridge" The members of 'NetdevNetmapOptions' when 'type' is "netmap" The members of 'NetdevVhostUserOptions' when 'type' is "vhost-user" Since: 1.2 -- Enum: NetFilterDirection Indicates whether a netfilter is attached to a netdev's transmit queue or receive queue or both. Values: 'all' the filter is attached both to the receive and the transmit queue of the netdev (default). 'rx' the filter is attached to the receive queue of the netdev, where it will receive packets sent to the netdev. 'tx' the filter is attached to the transmit queue of the netdev, where it will receive packets sent by the netdev. Since: 2.5 -- Enum: RxState Packets receiving state Values: 'normal' filter assigned packets according to the mac-table 'none' don't receive any assigned packet 'all' receive all assigned packets Since: 1.6 -- Object: RxFilterInfo Rx-filter information for a NIC. Members: 'name: string' net client name 'promiscuous: boolean' whether promiscuous mode is enabled 'multicast: RxState' multicast receive state 'unicast: RxState' unicast receive state 'vlan: RxState' vlan receive state (Since 2.0) 'broadcast-allowed: boolean' whether to receive broadcast 'multicast-overflow: boolean' multicast table is overflowed or not 'unicast-overflow: boolean' unicast table is overflowed or not 'main-mac: string' the main macaddr string 'vlan-table: array of int' a list of active vlan id 'unicast-table: array of string' a list of unicast macaddr string 'multicast-table: array of string' a list of multicast macaddr string Since: 1.6 -- Command: query-rx-filter Return rx-filter information for all NICs (or for the given NIC). Arguments: 'name: string' (optional) net client name Returns: list of 'RxFilterInfo' for all NICs (or for the given NIC). Returns an error if the given 'name' doesn't exist, or given NIC doesn't support rx-filter querying, or given net client isn't a NIC. Since: 1.6 Example: -> { "execute": "query-rx-filter", "arguments": { "name": "vnet0" } } <- { "return": [ { "promiscuous": true, "name": "vnet0", "main-mac": "52:54:00:12:34:56", "unicast": "normal", "vlan": "normal", "vlan-table": [ 4, 0 ], "unicast-table": [ ], "multicast": "normal", "multicast-overflow": false, "unicast-overflow": false, "multicast-table": [ "01:00:5e:00:00:01", "33:33:00:00:00:01", "33:33:ff:12:34:56" ], "broadcast-allowed": false } ] } -- Event: NIC_RX_FILTER_CHANGED Emitted once until the 'query-rx-filter' command is executed, the first event will always be emitted Arguments: 'name: string' (optional) net client name 'path: string' device path Since: 1.6 Example: <- { "event": "NIC_RX_FILTER_CHANGED", "data": { "name": "vnet0", "path": "/machine/peripheral/vnet0/virtio-backend" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1368697518, "microseconds": 326866 } } } -- Object: AnnounceParameters Parameters for self-announce timers Members: 'initial: int' Initial delay (in ms) before sending the first GARP/RARP announcement 'max: int' Maximum delay (in ms) between GARP/RARP announcement packets 'rounds: int' Number of self-announcement attempts 'step: int' Delay increase (in ms) after each self-announcement attempt 'interfaces: array of string' (optional) An optional list of interface names, which restricts the announcement to the listed interfaces. (Since 4.1) 'id: string' (optional) A name to be used to identify an instance of announce-timers and to allow it to modified later. Not for use as part of the migration parameters. (Since 4.1) Since: 4.0 -- Command: announce-self Trigger generation of broadcast RARP frames to update network switches. This can be useful when network bonds fail-over the active slave. Arguments: the members of 'AnnounceParameters' Example: -> { "execute": "announce-self", "arguments": { "initial": 50, "max": 550, "rounds": 10, "step": 50, "interfaces": ["vn2", "vn3"], "id": "bob" } } <- { "return": {} } Since: 4.0 1.11 RDMA device ================ -- Event: RDMA_GID_STATUS_CHANGED Emitted when guest driver adds/deletes GID to/from device Arguments: 'netdev: string' RoCE Network Device name 'gid-status: boolean' Add or delete indication 'subnet-prefix: int' Subnet Prefix 'interface-id: int' Not documented 'interface-id' : Interface ID Since: 4.0 Example: <- {"timestamp": {"seconds": 1541579657, "microseconds": 986760}, "event": "RDMA_GID_STATUS_CHANGED", "data": {"netdev": "bridge0", "interface-id": 15880512517475447892, "gid-status": true, "subnet-prefix": 33022}} 1.12 Rocker switch device ========================= -- Object: RockerSwitch Rocker switch information. Members: 'name: string' switch name 'id: int' switch ID 'ports: int' number of front-panel ports Since: 2.4 -- Command: query-rocker Return rocker switch information. Arguments: 'name: string' Not documented Returns: 'Rocker' information Since: 2.4 Example: -> { "execute": "query-rocker", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } } <- { "return": {"name": "sw1", "ports": 2, "id": 1327446905938}} -- Enum: RockerPortDuplex An eumeration of port duplex states. Values: 'half' half duplex 'full' full duplex Since: 2.4 -- Enum: RockerPortAutoneg An eumeration of port autoneg states. Values: 'off' autoneg is off 'on' autoneg is on Since: 2.4 -- Object: RockerPort Rocker switch port information. Members: 'name: string' port name 'enabled: boolean' port is enabled for I/O 'link-up: boolean' physical link is UP on port 'speed: int' port link speed in Mbps 'duplex: RockerPortDuplex' port link duplex 'autoneg: RockerPortAutoneg' port link autoneg Since: 2.4 -- Command: query-rocker-ports Return rocker switch port information. Arguments: 'name: string' Not documented Returns: a list of 'RockerPort' information Since: 2.4 Example: -> { "execute": "query-rocker-ports", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } } <- { "return": [ {"duplex": "full", "enabled": true, "name": "sw1.1", "autoneg": "off", "link-up": true, "speed": 10000}, {"duplex": "full", "enabled": true, "name": "sw1.2", "autoneg": "off", "link-up": true, "speed": 10000} ]} -- Object: RockerOfDpaFlowKey Rocker switch OF-DPA flow key Members: 'priority: int' key priority, 0 being lowest priority 'tbl-id: int' flow table ID 'in-pport: int' (optional) physical input port 'tunnel-id: int' (optional) tunnel ID 'vlan-id: int' (optional) VLAN ID 'eth-type: int' (optional) Ethernet header type 'eth-src: string' (optional) Ethernet header source MAC address 'eth-dst: string' (optional) Ethernet header destination MAC address 'ip-proto: int' (optional) IP Header protocol field 'ip-tos: int' (optional) IP header TOS field 'ip-dst: string' (optional) IP header destination address Note: optional members may or may not appear in the flow key depending if they're relevant to the flow key. Since: 2.4 -- Object: RockerOfDpaFlowMask Rocker switch OF-DPA flow mask Members: 'in-pport: int' (optional) physical input port 'tunnel-id: int' (optional) tunnel ID 'vlan-id: int' (optional) VLAN ID 'eth-src: string' (optional) Ethernet header source MAC address 'eth-dst: string' (optional) Ethernet header destination MAC address 'ip-proto: int' (optional) IP Header protocol field 'ip-tos: int' (optional) IP header TOS field Note: optional members may or may not appear in the flow mask depending if they're relevant to the flow mask. Since: 2.4 -- Object: RockerOfDpaFlowAction Rocker switch OF-DPA flow action Members: 'goto-tbl: int' (optional) next table ID 'group-id: int' (optional) group ID 'tunnel-lport: int' (optional) tunnel logical port ID 'vlan-id: int' (optional) VLAN ID 'new-vlan-id: int' (optional) new VLAN ID 'out-pport: int' (optional) physical output port Note: optional members may or may not appear in the flow action depending if they're relevant to the flow action. Since: 2.4 -- Object: RockerOfDpaFlow Rocker switch OF-DPA flow Members: 'cookie: int' flow unique cookie ID 'hits: int' count of matches (hits) on flow 'key: RockerOfDpaFlowKey' flow key 'mask: RockerOfDpaFlowMask' flow mask 'action: RockerOfDpaFlowAction' flow action Since: 2.4 -- Command: query-rocker-of-dpa-flows Return rocker OF-DPA flow information. Arguments: 'name: string' switch name 'tbl-id: int' (optional) flow table ID. If tbl-id is not specified, returns flow information for all tables. Returns: rocker OF-DPA flow information Since: 2.4 Example: -> { "execute": "query-rocker-of-dpa-flows", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } } <- { "return": [ {"key": {"in-pport": 0, "priority": 1, "tbl-id": 0}, "hits": 138, "cookie": 0, "action": {"goto-tbl": 10}, "mask": {"in-pport": 4294901760} }, {...more...}, ]} -- Object: RockerOfDpaGroup Rocker switch OF-DPA group Members: 'id: int' group unique ID 'type: int' group type 'vlan-id: int' (optional) VLAN ID 'pport: int' (optional) physical port number 'index: int' (optional) group index, unique with group type 'out-pport: int' (optional) output physical port number 'group-id: int' (optional) next group ID 'set-vlan-id: int' (optional) VLAN ID to set 'pop-vlan: int' (optional) pop VLAN headr from packet 'group-ids: array of int' (optional) list of next group IDs 'set-eth-src: string' (optional) set source MAC address in Ethernet header 'set-eth-dst: string' (optional) set destination MAC address in Ethernet header 'ttl-check: int' (optional) perform TTL check Note: optional members may or may not appear in the group depending if they're relevant to the group type. Since: 2.4 -- Command: query-rocker-of-dpa-groups Return rocker OF-DPA group information. Arguments: 'name: string' switch name 'type: int' (optional) group type. If type is not specified, returns group information for all group types. Returns: rocker OF-DPA group information Since: 2.4 Example: -> { "execute": "query-rocker-of-dpa-groups", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } } <- { "return": [ {"type": 0, "out-pport": 2, "pport": 2, "vlan-id": 3841, "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251723778}, {"type": 0, "out-pport": 0, "pport": 0, "vlan-id": 3841, "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251723776}, {"type": 0, "out-pport": 1, "pport": 1, "vlan-id": 3840, "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251658241}, {"type": 0, "out-pport": 0, "pport": 0, "vlan-id": 3840, "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251658240} ]} 1.13 TPM (trusted platform module) devices ========================================== -- Enum: TpmModel An enumeration of TPM models Values: 'tpm-tis' TPM TIS model 'tpm-crb' TPM CRB model (since 2.12) Since: 1.5 -- Command: query-tpm-models Return a list of supported TPM models Returns: a list of TpmModel Since: 1.5 Example: -> { "execute": "query-tpm-models" } <- { "return": [ "tpm-tis", "tpm-crb" ] } -- Enum: TpmType An enumeration of TPM types Values: 'passthrough' TPM passthrough type 'emulator' Software Emulator TPM type Since: 2.11 Since: 1.5 -- Command: query-tpm-types Return a list of supported TPM types Returns: a list of TpmType Since: 1.5 Example: -> { "execute": "query-tpm-types" } <- { "return": [ "passthrough", "emulator" ] } -- Object: TPMPassthroughOptions Information about the TPM passthrough type Members: 'path: string' (optional) string describing the path used for accessing the TPM device 'cancel-path: string' (optional) string showing the TPM's sysfs cancel file for cancellation of TPM commands while they are executing Since: 1.5 -- Object: TPMEmulatorOptions Information about the TPM emulator type Members: 'chardev: string' Name of a unix socket chardev Since: 2.11 -- Object: TpmTypeOptions A union referencing different TPM backend types' configuration options Members: 'type' 'passthrough' The configuration options for the TPM passthrough type 'emulator' The configuration options for TPM emulator backend type 'data: TPMPassthroughOptions' when 'type' is "passthrough" 'data: TPMEmulatorOptions' when 'type' is "emulator" Since: 1.5 -- Object: TPMInfo Information about the TPM Members: 'id: string' The Id of the TPM 'model: TpmModel' The TPM frontend model 'options: TpmTypeOptions' The TPM (backend) type configuration options Since: 1.5 -- Command: query-tpm Return information about the TPM device Returns: 'TPMInfo' on success Since: 1.5 Example: -> { "execute": "query-tpm" } <- { "return": [ { "model": "tpm-tis", "options": { "type": "passthrough", "data": { "cancel-path": "/sys/class/misc/tpm0/device/cancel", "path": "/dev/tpm0" } }, "id": "tpm0" } ] } 1.14 Remote desktop =================== -- Command: set_password Sets the password of a remote display session. Arguments: 'protocol: string' 'vnc' to modify the VNC server password 'spice' to modify the Spice server password 'password: string' the new password 'connected: string' (optional) how to handle existing clients when changing the password. If nothing is specified, defaults to 'keep' 'fail' to fail the command if clients are connected 'disconnect' to disconnect existing clients 'keep' to maintain existing clients Returns: Nothing on success If Spice is not enabled, DeviceNotFound Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "set_password", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc", "password": "secret" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: expire_password Expire the password of a remote display server. Arguments: 'protocol: string' the name of the remote display protocol 'vnc' or 'spice' 'time: string' when to expire the password. 'now' to expire the password immediately 'never' to cancel password expiration '+INT' where INT is the number of seconds from now (integer) 'INT' where INT is the absolute time in seconds Returns: Nothing on success If 'protocol' is 'spice' and Spice is not active, DeviceNotFound Since: 0.14.0 Notes: Time is relative to the server and currently there is no way to coordinate server time with client time. It is not recommended to use the absolute time version of the 'time' parameter unless you're sure you are on the same machine as the QEMU instance. Example: -> { "execute": "expire_password", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc", "time": "+60" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: screendump Write a PPM of the VGA screen to a file. Arguments: 'filename: string' the path of a new PPM file to store the image 'device: string' (optional) ID of the display device that should be dumped. If this parameter is missing, the primary display will be used. (Since 2.12) 'head: int' (optional) head to use in case the device supports multiple heads. If this parameter is missing, head #0 will be used. Also note that the head can only be specified in conjunction with the device ID. (Since 2.12) Returns: Nothing on success Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "screendump", "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/image" } } <- { "return": {} } 1.14.1 Spice ------------ -- Object: SpiceBasicInfo The basic information for SPICE network connection Members: 'host: string' IP address 'port: string' port number 'family: NetworkAddressFamily' address family Since: 2.1 If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)' -- Object: SpiceServerInfo Information about a SPICE server Members: 'auth: string' (optional) authentication method The members of 'SpiceBasicInfo' Since: 2.1 If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)' -- Object: SpiceChannel Information about a SPICE client channel. Members: 'connection-id: int' SPICE connection id number. All channels with the same id belong to the same SPICE session. 'channel-type: int' SPICE channel type number. "1" is the main control channel, filter for this one if you want to track spice sessions only 'channel-id: int' SPICE channel ID number. Usually "0", might be different when multiple channels of the same type exist, such as multiple display channels in a multihead setup 'tls: boolean' true if the channel is encrypted, false otherwise. The members of 'SpiceBasicInfo' Since: 0.14.0 If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)' -- Enum: SpiceQueryMouseMode An enumeration of Spice mouse states. Values: 'client' Mouse cursor position is determined by the client. 'server' Mouse cursor position is determined by the server. 'unknown' No information is available about mouse mode used by the spice server. Note: spice/enums.h has a SpiceMouseMode already, hence the name. Since: 1.1 If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)' -- Object: SpiceInfo Information about the SPICE session. Members: 'enabled: boolean' true if the SPICE server is enabled, false otherwise 'migrated: boolean' true if the last guest migration completed and spice migration had completed as well. false otherwise. (since 1.4) 'host: string' (optional) The hostname the SPICE server is bound to. This depends on the name resolution on the host and may be an IP address. 'port: int' (optional) The SPICE server's port number. 'compiled-version: string' (optional) SPICE server version. 'tls-port: int' (optional) The SPICE server's TLS port number. 'auth: string' (optional) the current authentication type used by the server 'none' if no authentication is being used 'spice' uses SASL or direct TLS authentication, depending on command line options 'mouse-mode: SpiceQueryMouseMode' The mode in which the mouse cursor is displayed currently. Can be determined by the client or the server, or unknown if spice server doesn't provide this information. (since: 1.1) 'channels: array of SpiceChannel' (optional) a list of 'SpiceChannel' for each active spice channel Since: 0.14.0 If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)' -- Command: query-spice Returns information about the current SPICE server Returns: 'SpiceInfo' Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-spice" } <- { "return": { "enabled": true, "auth": "spice", "port": 5920, "tls-port": 5921, "host": "0.0.0.0", "channels": [ { "port": "54924", "family": "ipv4", "channel-type": 1, "connection-id": 1804289383, "host": "127.0.0.1", "channel-id": 0, "tls": true }, { "port": "36710", "family": "ipv4", "channel-type": 4, "connection-id": 1804289383, "host": "127.0.0.1", "channel-id": 0, "tls": false }, [ ... more channels follow ... ] ] } } If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)' -- Event: SPICE_CONNECTED Emitted when a SPICE client establishes a connection Arguments: 'server: SpiceBasicInfo' server information 'client: SpiceBasicInfo' client information Since: 0.14.0 Example: <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 388707}, "event": "SPICE_CONNECTED", "data": { "server": { "port": "5920", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"}, "client": {"port": "52873", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"} }} If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)' -- Event: SPICE_INITIALIZED Emitted after initial handshake and authentication takes place (if any) and the SPICE channel is up and running Arguments: 'server: SpiceServerInfo' server information 'client: SpiceChannel' client information Since: 0.14.0 Example: <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 417172}, "event": "SPICE_INITIALIZED", "data": {"server": {"auth": "spice", "port": "5921", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"}, "client": {"port": "49004", "family": "ipv4", "channel-type": 3, "connection-id": 1804289383, "host": "127.0.0.1", "channel-id": 0, "tls": true} }} If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)' -- Event: SPICE_DISCONNECTED Emitted when the SPICE connection is closed Arguments: 'server: SpiceBasicInfo' server information 'client: SpiceBasicInfo' client information Since: 0.14.0 Example: <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 388707}, "event": "SPICE_DISCONNECTED", "data": { "server": { "port": "5920", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"}, "client": {"port": "52873", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"} }} If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)' -- Event: SPICE_MIGRATE_COMPLETED Emitted when SPICE migration has completed Since: 1.3 Example: <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 417172}, "event": "SPICE_MIGRATE_COMPLETED" } If: 'defined(CONFIG_SPICE)' 1.14.2 VNC ---------- -- Object: VncBasicInfo The basic information for vnc network connection Members: 'host: string' IP address 'service: string' The service name of the vnc port. This may depend on the host system's service database so symbolic names should not be relied on. 'family: NetworkAddressFamily' address family 'websocket: boolean' true in case the socket is a websocket (since 2.3). Since: 2.1 If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' -- Object: VncServerInfo The network connection information for server Members: 'auth: string' (optional) authentication method used for the plain (non-websocket) VNC server The members of 'VncBasicInfo' Since: 2.1 If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' -- Object: VncClientInfo Information about a connected VNC client. Members: 'x509_dname: string' (optional) If x509 authentication is in use, the Distinguished Name of the client. 'sasl_username: string' (optional) If SASL authentication is in use, the SASL username used for authentication. The members of 'VncBasicInfo' Since: 0.14.0 If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' -- Object: VncInfo Information about the VNC session. Members: 'enabled: boolean' true if the VNC server is enabled, false otherwise 'host: string' (optional) The hostname the VNC server is bound to. This depends on the name resolution on the host and may be an IP address. 'family: NetworkAddressFamily' (optional) 'ipv6' if the host is listening for IPv6 connections 'ipv4' if the host is listening for IPv4 connections 'unix' if the host is listening on a unix domain socket 'unknown' otherwise 'service: string' (optional) The service name of the server's port. This may depends on the host system's service database so symbolic names should not be relied on. 'auth: string' (optional) the current authentication type used by the server 'none' if no authentication is being used 'vnc' if VNC authentication is being used 'vencrypt+plain' if VEncrypt is used with plain text authentication 'vencrypt+tls+none' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and no authentication 'vencrypt+tls+vnc' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and VNC authentication 'vencrypt+tls+plain' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and plain text auth 'vencrypt+x509+none' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and no auth 'vencrypt+x509+vnc' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and VNC auth 'vencrypt+x509+plain' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and plain text auth 'vencrypt+tls+sasl' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and SASL auth 'vencrypt+x509+sasl' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and SASL auth 'clients: array of VncClientInfo' (optional) a list of 'VncClientInfo' of all currently connected clients Since: 0.14.0 If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' -- Enum: VncPrimaryAuth vnc primary authentication method. Values: 'none' Not documented 'vnc' Not documented 'ra2' Not documented 'ra2ne' Not documented 'tight' Not documented 'ultra' Not documented 'tls' Not documented 'vencrypt' Not documented 'sasl' Not documented Since: 2.3 If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' -- Enum: VncVencryptSubAuth vnc sub authentication method with vencrypt. Values: 'plain' Not documented 'tls-none' Not documented 'x509-none' Not documented 'tls-vnc' Not documented 'x509-vnc' Not documented 'tls-plain' Not documented 'x509-plain' Not documented 'tls-sasl' Not documented 'x509-sasl' Not documented Since: 2.3 If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' -- Object: VncServerInfo2 The network connection information for server Members: 'auth: VncPrimaryAuth' The current authentication type used by the servers 'vencrypt: VncVencryptSubAuth' (optional) The vencrypt sub authentication type used by the servers, only specified in case auth == vencrypt. The members of 'VncBasicInfo' Since: 2.9 If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' -- Object: VncInfo2 Information about a vnc server Members: 'id: string' vnc server name. 'server: array of VncServerInfo2' A list of 'VncBasincInfo' describing all listening sockets. The list can be empty (in case the vnc server is disabled). It also may have multiple entries: normal + websocket, possibly also ipv4 + ipv6 in the future. 'clients: array of VncClientInfo' A list of 'VncClientInfo' of all currently connected clients. The list can be empty, for obvious reasons. 'auth: VncPrimaryAuth' The current authentication type used by the non-websockets servers 'vencrypt: VncVencryptSubAuth' (optional) The vencrypt authentication type used by the servers, only specified in case auth == vencrypt. 'display: string' (optional) The display device the vnc server is linked to. Since: 2.3 If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' -- Command: query-vnc Returns information about the current VNC server Returns: 'VncInfo' Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-vnc" } <- { "return": { "enabled":true, "host":"0.0.0.0", "service":"50402", "auth":"vnc", "family":"ipv4", "clients":[ { "host":"127.0.0.1", "service":"50401", "family":"ipv4" } ] } } If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' -- Command: query-vnc-servers Returns a list of vnc servers. The list can be empty. Returns: a list of 'VncInfo2' Since: 2.3 If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' -- Command: change-vnc-password Change the VNC server password. Arguments: 'password: string' the new password to use with VNC authentication Since: 1.1 Notes: An empty password in this command will set the password to the empty string. Existing clients are unaffected by executing this command. If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' -- Event: VNC_CONNECTED Emitted when a VNC client establishes a connection Arguments: 'server: VncServerInfo' server information 'client: VncBasicInfo' client information Note: This event is emitted before any authentication takes place, thus the authentication ID is not provided Since: 0.13.0 Example: <- { "event": "VNC_CONNECTED", "data": { "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4", "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0" }, "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "58425", "host": "127.0.0.1" } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1262976601, "microseconds": 975795 } } If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' -- Event: VNC_INITIALIZED Emitted after authentication takes place (if any) and the VNC session is made active Arguments: 'server: VncServerInfo' server information 'client: VncClientInfo' client information Since: 0.13.0 Example: <- { "event": "VNC_INITIALIZED", "data": { "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4", "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0"}, "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "46089", "host": "127.0.0.1", "sasl_username": "luiz" } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1263475302, "microseconds": 150772 } } If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' -- Event: VNC_DISCONNECTED Emitted when the connection is closed Arguments: 'server: VncServerInfo' server information 'client: VncClientInfo' client information Since: 0.13.0 Example: <- { "event": "VNC_DISCONNECTED", "data": { "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4", "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0" }, "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "58425", "host": "127.0.0.1", "sasl_username": "luiz" } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1262976601, "microseconds": 975795 } } If: 'defined(CONFIG_VNC)' 1.15 Input ========== -- Object: MouseInfo Information about a mouse device. Members: 'name: string' the name of the mouse device 'index: int' the index of the mouse device 'current: boolean' true if this device is currently receiving mouse events 'absolute: boolean' true if this device supports absolute coordinates as input Since: 0.14.0 -- Command: query-mice Returns information about each active mouse device Returns: a list of 'MouseInfo' for each device Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-mice" } <- { "return": [ { "name":"QEMU Microsoft Mouse", "index":0, "current":false, "absolute":false }, { "name":"QEMU PS/2 Mouse", "index":1, "current":true, "absolute":true } ] } -- Enum: QKeyCode An enumeration of key name. This is used by the 'send-key' command. Values: 'unmapped' since 2.0 'pause' since 2.0 'ro' since 2.4 'kp_comma' since 2.4 'kp_equals' since 2.6 'power' since 2.6 'hiragana' since 2.9 'henkan' since 2.9 'yen' since 2.9 'sleep' since 2.10 'wake' since 2.10 'audionext' since 2.10 'audioprev' since 2.10 'audiostop' since 2.10 'audioplay' since 2.10 'audiomute' since 2.10 'volumeup' since 2.10 'volumedown' since 2.10 'mediaselect' since 2.10 'mail' since 2.10 'calculator' since 2.10 'computer' since 2.10 'ac_home' since 2.10 'ac_back' since 2.10 'ac_forward' since 2.10 'ac_refresh' since 2.10 'ac_bookmarks' since 2.10 altgr, altgr_r: dropped in 2.10 'muhenkan' since 2.12 'katakanahiragana' since 2.12 'shift' Not documented 'shift_r' Not documented 'alt' Not documented 'alt_r' Not documented 'ctrl' Not documented 'ctrl_r' Not documented 'menu' Not documented 'esc' Not documented '1' Not documented '2' Not documented '3' Not documented '4' Not documented '5' Not documented '6' Not documented '7' Not documented '8' Not documented '9' Not documented '0' Not documented 'minus' Not documented 'equal' Not documented 'backspace' Not documented 'tab' Not documented 'q' Not documented 'w' Not documented 'e' Not documented 'r' Not documented 't' Not documented 'y' Not documented 'u' Not documented 'i' Not documented 'o' Not documented 'p' Not documented 'bracket_left' Not documented 'bracket_right' Not documented 'ret' Not documented 'a' Not documented 's' Not documented 'd' Not documented 'f' Not documented 'g' Not documented 'h' Not documented 'j' Not documented 'k' Not documented 'l' Not documented 'semicolon' Not documented 'apostrophe' Not documented 'grave_accent' Not documented 'backslash' Not documented 'z' Not documented 'x' Not documented 'c' Not documented 'v' Not documented 'b' Not documented 'n' Not documented 'm' Not documented 'comma' Not documented 'dot' Not documented 'slash' Not documented 'asterisk' Not documented 'spc' Not documented 'caps_lock' Not documented 'f1' Not documented 'f2' Not documented 'f3' Not documented 'f4' Not documented 'f5' Not documented 'f6' Not documented 'f7' Not documented 'f8' Not documented 'f9' Not documented 'f10' Not documented 'num_lock' Not documented 'scroll_lock' Not documented 'kp_divide' Not documented 'kp_multiply' Not documented 'kp_subtract' Not documented 'kp_add' Not documented 'kp_enter' Not documented 'kp_decimal' Not documented 'sysrq' Not documented 'kp_0' Not documented 'kp_1' Not documented 'kp_2' Not documented 'kp_3' Not documented 'kp_4' Not documented 'kp_5' Not documented 'kp_6' Not documented 'kp_7' Not documented 'kp_8' Not documented 'kp_9' Not documented 'less' Not documented 'f11' Not documented 'f12' Not documented 'print' Not documented 'home' Not documented 'pgup' Not documented 'pgdn' Not documented 'end' Not documented 'left' Not documented 'up' Not documented 'down' Not documented 'right' Not documented 'insert' Not documented 'delete' Not documented 'stop' Not documented 'again' Not documented 'props' Not documented 'undo' Not documented 'front' Not documented 'copy' Not documented 'open' Not documented 'paste' Not documented 'find' Not documented 'cut' Not documented 'lf' Not documented 'help' Not documented 'meta_l' Not documented 'meta_r' Not documented 'compose' Not documented 'sysrq' was mistakenly added to hack around the fact that the ps2 driver was not generating correct scancodes sequences when 'alt+print' was pressed. This flaw is now fixed and the 'sysrq' key serves no further purpose. Any further use of 'sysrq' will be transparently changed to 'print', so they are effectively synonyms. Since: 1.3.0 -- Object: KeyValue Represents a keyboard key. Members: 'type' One of "number", "qcode" 'data: int' when 'type' is "number" 'data: QKeyCode' when 'type' is "qcode" Since: 1.3.0 -- Command: send-key Send keys to guest. Arguments: 'keys: array of KeyValue' An array of 'KeyValue' elements. All 'KeyValues' in this array are simultaneously sent to the guest. A 'KeyValue'.number value is sent directly to the guest, while 'KeyValue'.qcode must be a valid 'QKeyCode' value 'hold-time: int' (optional) time to delay key up events, milliseconds. Defaults to 100 Returns: Nothing on success If key is unknown or redundant, InvalidParameter Since: 1.3.0 Example: -> { "execute": "send-key", "arguments": { "keys": [ { "type": "qcode", "data": "ctrl" }, { "type": "qcode", "data": "alt" }, { "type": "qcode", "data": "delete" } ] } } <- { "return": {} } -- Enum: InputButton Button of a pointer input device (mouse, tablet). Values: 'side' front side button of a 5-button mouse (since 2.9) 'extra' rear side button of a 5-button mouse (since 2.9) 'left' Not documented 'middle' Not documented 'right' Not documented 'wheel-up' Not documented 'wheel-down' Not documented Since: 2.0 -- Enum: InputAxis Position axis of a pointer input device (mouse, tablet). Values: 'x' Not documented 'y' Not documented Since: 2.0 -- Object: InputKeyEvent Keyboard input event. Members: 'key: KeyValue' Which key this event is for. 'down: boolean' True for key-down and false for key-up events. Since: 2.0 -- Object: InputBtnEvent Pointer button input event. Members: 'button: InputButton' Which button this event is for. 'down: boolean' True for key-down and false for key-up events. Since: 2.0 -- Object: InputMoveEvent Pointer motion input event. Members: 'axis: InputAxis' Which axis is referenced by 'value'. 'value: int' Pointer position. For absolute coordinates the valid range is 0 -> 0x7ffff Since: 2.0 -- Object: InputEvent Input event union. Members: 'type' the input type, one of: - 'key': Input event of Keyboard - 'btn': Input event of pointer buttons - 'rel': Input event of relative pointer motion - 'abs': Input event of absolute pointer motion 'data: InputKeyEvent' when 'type' is "key" 'data: InputBtnEvent' when 'type' is "btn" 'data: InputMoveEvent' when 'type' is "rel" 'data: InputMoveEvent' when 'type' is "abs" Since: 2.0 -- Command: input-send-event Send input event(s) to guest. Arguments: 'device: string' (optional) display device to send event(s) to. 'head: int' (optional) head to send event(s) to, in case the display device supports multiple scanouts. 'events: array of InputEvent' List of InputEvent union. Returns: Nothing on success. The 'device' and 'head' parameters can be used to send the input event to specific input devices in case (a) multiple input devices of the same kind are added to the virtual machine and (b) you have configured input routing (see docs/multiseat.txt) for those input devices. The parameters work exactly like the device and head properties of input devices. If 'device' is missing, only devices that have no input routing config are admissible. If 'device' is specified, both input devices with and without input routing config are admissible, but devices with input routing config take precedence. Since: 2.6 Note: The consoles are visible in the qom tree, under /backend/console[$index]. They have a device link and head property, so it is possible to map which console belongs to which device and display. Example: 1. Press left mouse button. -> { "execute": "input-send-event", "arguments": { "device": "video0", "events": [ { "type": "btn", "data" : { "down": true, "button": "left" } } ] } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "input-send-event", "arguments": { "device": "video0", "events": [ { "type": "btn", "data" : { "down": false, "button": "left" } } ] } } <- { "return": {} } 2. Press ctrl-alt-del. -> { "execute": "input-send-event", "arguments": { "events": [ { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true, "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "ctrl" } } }, { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true, "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "alt" } } }, { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true, "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "delete" } } } ] } } <- { "return": {} } 3. Move mouse pointer to absolute coordinates (20000, 400). -> { "execute": "input-send-event" , "arguments": { "events": [ { "type": "abs", "data" : { "axis": "x", "value" : 20000 } }, { "type": "abs", "data" : { "axis": "y", "value" : 400 } } ] } } <- { "return": {} } -- Enum: GrabToggleKeys Keys to toggle input-linux between host and guest. Values: 'ctrl-ctrl' Not documented 'alt-alt' Not documented 'meta-meta' Not documented 'scrolllock' Not documented 'ctrl-scrolllock' Not documented Since: 4.0 -- Object: DisplayGTK GTK display options. Members: 'grab-on-hover: boolean' (optional) Grab keyboard input on mouse hover. 'zoom-to-fit: boolean' (optional) Zoom guest display to fit into the host window. When turned off the host window will be resized instead. In case the display device can notify the guest on window resizes (virtio-gpu) this will default to "on", assuming the guest will resize the display to match the window size then. Otherwise it defaults to "off". Since 3.1 Since: 2.12 -- Object: DisplayEGLHeadless EGL headless display options. Members: 'rendernode: string' (optional) Which DRM render node should be used. Default is the first available node on the host. Since: 3.1 -- Enum: DisplayGLMode Display OpenGL mode. Values: 'off' Disable OpenGL (default). 'on' Use OpenGL, pick context type automatically. Would better be named 'auto' but is called 'on' for backward compatibility with bool type. 'core' Use OpenGL with Core (desktop) Context. 'es' Use OpenGL with ES (embedded systems) Context. Since: 3.0 -- Object: DisplayCurses Curses display options. Members: 'charset: string' (optional) Font charset used by guest (default: CP437). Since: 4.0 -- Enum: DisplayType Display (user interface) type. Values: 'default' The default user interface, selecting from the first available of gtk, sdl, cocoa, and vnc. 'none' No user interface or video output display. The guest will still see an emulated graphics card, but its output will not be displayed to the QEMU user. 'gtk' The GTK user interface. 'sdl' The SDL user interface. 'egl-headless' No user interface, offload GL operations to a local DRI device. Graphical display need to be paired with VNC or Spice. (Since 3.1) 'curses' Display video output via curses. For graphics device models which support a text mode, QEMU can display this output using a curses/ncurses interface. Nothing is displayed when the graphics device is in graphical mode or if the graphics device does not support a text mode. Generally only the VGA device models support text mode. 'cocoa' The Cocoa user interface. 'spice-app' Set up a Spice server and run the default associated application to connect to it. The server will redirect the serial console and QEMU monitors. (Since 4.0) Since: 2.12 -- Object: DisplayOptions Display (user interface) options. Members: 'type: DisplayType' Which DisplayType qemu should use. 'full-screen: boolean' (optional) Start user interface in fullscreen mode (default: off). 'window-close: boolean' (optional) Allow to quit qemu with window close button (default: on). 'gl: DisplayGLMode' (optional) Enable OpenGL support (default: off). The members of 'DisplayGTK' when 'type' is "gtk" The members of 'DisplayCurses' when 'type' is "curses" The members of 'DisplayEGLHeadless' when 'type' is "egl-headless" Since: 2.12 -- Command: query-display-options Returns information about display configuration Returns: 'DisplayOptions' Since: 3.1 -- Enum: QAuthZListPolicy The authorization policy result Values: 'deny' deny access 'allow' allow access Since: 4.0 -- Enum: QAuthZListFormat The authorization policy match format Values: 'exact' an exact string match 'glob' string with ? and * shell wildcard support Since: 4.0 -- Object: QAuthZListRule A single authorization rule. Members: 'match: string' a string or glob to match against a user identity 'policy: QAuthZListPolicy' the result to return if 'match' evaluates to true 'format: QAuthZListFormat' (optional) the format of the 'match' rule (default 'exact') Since: 4.0 -- Object: QAuthZListRuleListHack Not exposed via QMP; hack to generate QAuthZListRuleList for use internally by the code. Members: 'unused: array of QAuthZListRule' Not documented Since: 4.0 1.16 Migration ============== -- Object: MigrationStats Detailed migration status. Members: 'transferred: int' amount of bytes already transferred to the target VM 'remaining: int' amount of bytes remaining to be transferred to the target VM 'total: int' total amount of bytes involved in the migration process 'duplicate: int' number of duplicate (zero) pages (since 1.2) 'skipped: int' number of skipped zero pages (since 1.5) 'normal: int' number of normal pages (since 1.2) 'normal-bytes: int' number of normal bytes sent (since 1.2) 'dirty-pages-rate: int' number of pages dirtied by second by the guest (since 1.3) 'mbps: number' throughput in megabits/sec. (since 1.6) 'dirty-sync-count: int' number of times that dirty ram was synchronized (since 2.1) 'postcopy-requests: int' The number of page requests received from the destination (since 2.7) 'page-size: int' The number of bytes per page for the various page-based statistics (since 2.10) 'multifd-bytes: int' The number of bytes sent through multifd (since 3.0) 'pages-per-second: int' the number of memory pages transferred per second (Since 4.0) Since: 0.14.0 -- Object: XBZRLECacheStats Detailed XBZRLE migration cache statistics Members: 'cache-size: int' XBZRLE cache size 'bytes: int' amount of bytes already transferred to the target VM 'pages: int' amount of pages transferred to the target VM 'cache-miss: int' number of cache miss 'cache-miss-rate: number' rate of cache miss (since 2.1) 'overflow: int' number of overflows Since: 1.2 -- Object: CompressionStats Detailed migration compression statistics Members: 'pages: int' amount of pages compressed and transferred to the target VM 'busy: int' count of times that no free thread was available to compress data 'busy-rate: number' rate of thread busy 'compressed-size: int' amount of bytes after compression 'compression-rate: number' rate of compressed size Since: 3.1 -- Enum: MigrationStatus An enumeration of migration status. Values: 'none' no migration has ever happened. 'setup' migration process has been initiated. 'cancelling' in the process of cancelling migration. 'cancelled' cancelling migration is finished. 'active' in the process of doing migration. 'postcopy-active' like active, but now in postcopy mode. (since 2.5) 'postcopy-paused' during postcopy but paused. (since 3.0) 'postcopy-recover' trying to recover from a paused postcopy. (since 3.0) 'completed' migration is finished. 'failed' some error occurred during migration process. 'colo' VM is in the process of fault tolerance, VM can not get into this state unless colo capability is enabled for migration. (since 2.8) 'pre-switchover' Paused before device serialisation. (since 2.11) 'device' During device serialisation when pause-before-switchover is enabled (since 2.11) Since: 2.3 -- Object: MigrationInfo Information about current migration process. Members: 'status: MigrationStatus' (optional) 'MigrationStatus' describing the current migration status. If this field is not returned, no migration process has been initiated 'ram: MigrationStats' (optional) 'MigrationStats' containing detailed migration status, only returned if status is 'active' or 'completed'(since 1.2) 'disk: MigrationStats' (optional) 'MigrationStats' containing detailed disk migration status, only returned if status is 'active' and it is a block migration 'xbzrle-cache: XBZRLECacheStats' (optional) 'XBZRLECacheStats' containing detailed XBZRLE migration statistics, only returned if XBZRLE feature is on and status is 'active' or 'completed' (since 1.2) 'total-time: int' (optional) total amount of milliseconds since migration started. If migration has ended, it returns the total migration time. (since 1.2) 'downtime: int' (optional) only present when migration finishes correctly total downtime in milliseconds for the guest. (since 1.3) 'expected-downtime: int' (optional) only present while migration is active expected downtime in milliseconds for the guest in last walk of the dirty bitmap. (since 1.3) 'setup-time: int' (optional) amount of setup time in milliseconds _before_ the iterations begin but _after_ the QMP command is issued. This is designed to provide an accounting of any activities (such as RDMA pinning) which may be expensive, but do not actually occur during the iterative migration rounds themselves. (since 1.6) 'cpu-throttle-percentage: int' (optional) percentage of time guest cpus are being throttled during auto-converge. This is only present when auto-converge has started throttling guest cpus. (Since 2.7) 'error-desc: string' (optional) the human readable error description string, when 'status' is 'failed'. Clients should not attempt to parse the error strings. (Since 2.7) 'postcopy-blocktime: int' (optional) total time when all vCPU were blocked during postcopy live migration. This is only present when the postcopy-blocktime migration capability is enabled. (Since 3.0) 'postcopy-vcpu-blocktime: array of int' (optional) list of the postcopy blocktime per vCPU. This is only present when the postcopy-blocktime migration capability is enabled. (Since 3.0) 'compression: CompressionStats' (optional) migration compression statistics, only returned if compression feature is on and status is 'active' or 'completed' (Since 3.1) 'socket-address: array of SocketAddress' (optional) Only used for tcp, to know what the real port is (Since 4.0) Since: 0.14.0 -- Command: query-migrate Returns information about current migration process. If migration is active there will be another json-object with RAM migration status and if block migration is active another one with block migration status. Returns: 'MigrationInfo' Since: 0.14.0 Example: 1. Before the first migration -> { "execute": "query-migrate" } <- { "return": {} } 2. Migration is done and has succeeded -> { "execute": "query-migrate" } <- { "return": { "status": "completed", "total-time":12345, "setup-time":12345, "downtime":12345, "ram":{ "transferred":123, "remaining":123, "total":246, "duplicate":123, "normal":123, "normal-bytes":123456, "dirty-sync-count":15 } } } 3. Migration is done and has failed -> { "execute": "query-migrate" } <- { "return": { "status": "failed" } } 4. Migration is being performed and is not a block migration: -> { "execute": "query-migrate" } <- { "return":{ "status":"active", "total-time":12345, "setup-time":12345, "expected-downtime":12345, "ram":{ "transferred":123, "remaining":123, "total":246, "duplicate":123, "normal":123, "normal-bytes":123456, "dirty-sync-count":15 } } } 5. Migration is being performed and is a block migration: -> { "execute": "query-migrate" } <- { "return":{ "status":"active", "total-time":12345, "setup-time":12345, "expected-downtime":12345, "ram":{ "total":1057024, "remaining":1053304, "transferred":3720, "duplicate":123, "normal":123, "normal-bytes":123456, "dirty-sync-count":15 }, "disk":{ "total":20971520, "remaining":20880384, "transferred":91136 } } } 6. Migration is being performed and XBZRLE is active: -> { "execute": "query-migrate" } <- { "return":{ "status":"active", "total-time":12345, "setup-time":12345, "expected-downtime":12345, "ram":{ "total":1057024, "remaining":1053304, "transferred":3720, "duplicate":10, "normal":3333, "normal-bytes":3412992, "dirty-sync-count":15 }, "xbzrle-cache":{ "cache-size":67108864, "bytes":20971520, "pages":2444343, "cache-miss":2244, "cache-miss-rate":0.123, "overflow":34434 } } } -- Enum: MigrationCapability Migration capabilities enumeration Values: 'xbzrle' Migration supports xbzrle (Xor Based Zero Run Length Encoding). This feature allows us to minimize migration traffic for certain work loads, by sending compressed difference of the pages 'rdma-pin-all' Controls whether or not the entire VM memory footprint is mlock()'d on demand or all at once. Refer to docs/rdma.txt for usage. Disabled by default. (since 2.0) 'zero-blocks' During storage migration encode blocks of zeroes efficiently. This essentially saves 1MB of zeroes per block on the wire. Enabling requires source and target VM to support this feature. To enable it is sufficient to enable the capability on the source VM. The feature is disabled by default. (since 1.6) 'compress' Use multiple compression threads to accelerate live migration. This feature can help to reduce the migration traffic, by sending compressed pages. Please note that if compress and xbzrle are both on, compress only takes effect in the ram bulk stage, after that, it will be disabled and only xbzrle takes effect, this can help to minimize migration traffic. The feature is disabled by default. (since 2.4 ) 'events' generate events for each migration state change (since 2.4 ) 'auto-converge' If enabled, QEMU will automatically throttle down the guest to speed up convergence of RAM migration. (since 1.6) 'postcopy-ram' Start executing on the migration target before all of RAM has been migrated, pulling the remaining pages along as needed. The capacity must have the same setting on both source and target or migration will not even start. NOTE: If the migration fails during postcopy the VM will fail. (since 2.6) 'x-colo' If enabled, migration will never end, and the state of the VM on the primary side will be migrated continuously to the VM on secondary side, this process is called COarse-Grain LOck Stepping (COLO) for Non-stop Service. (since 2.8) 'release-ram' if enabled, qemu will free the migrated ram pages on the source during postcopy-ram migration. (since 2.9) 'block' If enabled, QEMU will also migrate the contents of all block devices. Default is disabled. A possible alternative uses mirror jobs to a builtin NBD server on the destination, which offers more flexibility. (Since 2.10) 'return-path' If enabled, migration will use the return path even for precopy. (since 2.10) 'pause-before-switchover' Pause outgoing migration before serialising device state and before disabling block IO (since 2.11) 'multifd' Use more than one fd for migration (since 4.0) 'dirty-bitmaps' If enabled, QEMU will migrate named dirty bitmaps. (since 2.12) 'postcopy-blocktime' Calculate downtime for postcopy live migration (since 3.0) 'late-block-activate' If enabled, the destination will not activate block devices (and thus take locks) immediately at the end of migration. (since 3.0) 'x-ignore-shared' If enabled, QEMU will not migrate shared memory (since 4.0) Since: 1.2 -- Object: MigrationCapabilityStatus Migration capability information Members: 'capability: MigrationCapability' capability enum 'state: boolean' capability state bool Since: 1.2 -- Command: migrate-set-capabilities Enable/Disable the following migration capabilities (like xbzrle) Arguments: 'capabilities: array of MigrationCapabilityStatus' json array of capability modifications to make Since: 1.2 Example: -> { "execute": "migrate-set-capabilities" , "arguments": { "capabilities": [ { "capability": "xbzrle", "state": true } ] } } -- Command: query-migrate-capabilities Returns information about the current migration capabilities status Returns: 'MigrationCapabilitiesStatus' Since: 1.2 Example: -> { "execute": "query-migrate-capabilities" } <- { "return": [ {"state": false, "capability": "xbzrle"}, {"state": false, "capability": "rdma-pin-all"}, {"state": false, "capability": "auto-converge"}, {"state": false, "capability": "zero-blocks"}, {"state": false, "capability": "compress"}, {"state": true, "capability": "events"}, {"state": false, "capability": "postcopy-ram"}, {"state": false, "capability": "x-colo"} ]} -- Enum: MigrationParameter Migration parameters enumeration Values: 'announce-initial' Initial delay (in milliseconds) before sending the first announce (Since 4.0) 'announce-max' Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the announcement (Since 4.0) 'announce-rounds' Number of self-announce packets sent after migration (Since 4.0) 'announce-step' Increase in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent packets in the announcement (Since 4.0) 'compress-level' Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. 'compress-threads' Set compression thread count to be used in live migration, the compression thread count is an integer between 1 and 255. 'compress-wait-thread' Controls behavior when all compression threads are currently busy. If true (default), wait for a free compression thread to become available; otherwise, send the page uncompressed. (Since 3.1) 'decompress-threads' Set decompression thread count to be used in live migration, the decompression thread count is an integer between 1 and 255. Usually, decompression is at least 4 times as fast as compression, so set the decompress-threads to the number about 1/4 of compress-threads is adequate. 'cpu-throttle-initial' Initial percentage of time guest cpus are throttled when migration auto-converge is activated. The default value is 20. (Since 2.7) 'cpu-throttle-increment' throttle percentage increase each time auto-converge detects that migration is not making progress. The default value is 10. (Since 2.7) 'tls-creds' ID of the 'tls-creds' object that provides credentials for establishing a TLS connection over the migration data channel. On the outgoing side of the migration, the credentials must be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the incoming side the credentials must be for a 'server' endpoint. Setting this will enable TLS for all migrations. The default is unset, resulting in unsecured migration at the QEMU level. (Since 2.7) 'tls-hostname' hostname of the target host for the migration. This is required when using x509 based TLS credentials and the migration URI does not already include a hostname. For example if using fd: or exec: based migration, the hostname must be provided so that the server's x509 certificate identity can be validated. (Since 2.7) 'tls-authz' ID of the 'authz' object subclass that provides access control checking of the TLS x509 certificate distinguished name. This object is only resolved at time of use, so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the migration server is active. If missing, it will default to denying access (Since 4.0) 'max-bandwidth' to set maximum speed for migration. maximum speed in bytes per second. (Since 2.8) 'downtime-limit' set maximum tolerated downtime for migration. maximum downtime in milliseconds (Since 2.8) 'x-checkpoint-delay' The delay time (in ms) between two COLO checkpoints in periodic mode. (Since 2.8) 'block-incremental' Affects how much storage is migrated when the block migration capability is enabled. When false, the entire storage backing chain is migrated into a flattened image at the destination; when true, only the active qcow2 layer is migrated and the destination must already have access to the same backing chain as was used on the source. (since 2.10) 'multifd-channels' Number of channels used to migrate data in parallel. This is the same number that the number of sockets used for migration. The default value is 2 (since 4.0) 'xbzrle-cache-size' cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration. It needs to be a multiple of the target page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11) 'max-postcopy-bandwidth' Background transfer bandwidth during postcopy. Defaults to 0 (unlimited). In bytes per second. (Since 3.0) 'max-cpu-throttle' maximum cpu throttle percentage. Defaults to 99. (Since 3.1) Since: 2.4 -- Object: MigrateSetParameters Members: 'announce-initial: int' (optional) Initial delay (in milliseconds) before sending the first announce (Since 4.0) 'announce-max: int' (optional) Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the announcement (Since 4.0) 'announce-rounds: int' (optional) Number of self-announce packets sent after migration (Since 4.0) 'announce-step: int' (optional) Increase in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent packets in the announcement (Since 4.0) 'compress-level: int' (optional) compression level 'compress-threads: int' (optional) compression thread count 'compress-wait-thread: boolean' (optional) Controls behavior when all compression threads are currently busy. If true (default), wait for a free compression thread to become available; otherwise, send the page uncompressed. (Since 3.1) 'decompress-threads: int' (optional) decompression thread count 'cpu-throttle-initial: int' (optional) Initial percentage of time guest cpus are throttled when migration auto-converge is activated. The default value is 20. (Since 2.7) 'cpu-throttle-increment: int' (optional) throttle percentage increase each time auto-converge detects that migration is not making progress. The default value is 10. (Since 2.7) 'tls-creds: StrOrNull' (optional) ID of the 'tls-creds' object that provides credentials for establishing a TLS connection over the migration data channel. On the outgoing side of the migration, the credentials must be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the incoming side the credentials must be for a 'server' endpoint. Setting this to a non-empty string enables TLS for all migrations. An empty string means that QEMU will use plain text mode for migration, rather than TLS (Since 2.9) Previously (since 2.7), this was reported by omitting tls-creds instead. 'tls-hostname: StrOrNull' (optional) hostname of the target host for the migration. This is required when using x509 based TLS credentials and the migration URI does not already include a hostname. For example if using fd: or exec: based migration, the hostname must be provided so that the server's x509 certificate identity can be validated. (Since 2.7) An empty string means that QEMU will use the hostname associated with the migration URI, if any. (Since 2.9) Previously (since 2.7), this was reported by omitting tls-hostname instead. 'max-bandwidth: int' (optional) to set maximum speed for migration. maximum speed in bytes per second. (Since 2.8) 'downtime-limit: int' (optional) set maximum tolerated downtime for migration. maximum downtime in milliseconds (Since 2.8) 'x-checkpoint-delay: int' (optional) the delay time between two COLO checkpoints. (Since 2.8) 'block-incremental: boolean' (optional) Affects how much storage is migrated when the block migration capability is enabled. When false, the entire storage backing chain is migrated into a flattened image at the destination; when true, only the active qcow2 layer is migrated and the destination must already have access to the same backing chain as was used on the source. (since 2.10) 'multifd-channels: int' (optional) Number of channels used to migrate data in parallel. This is the same number that the number of sockets used for migration. The default value is 2 (since 4.0) 'xbzrle-cache-size: int' (optional) cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration. It needs to be a multiple of the target page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11) 'max-postcopy-bandwidth: int' (optional) Background transfer bandwidth during postcopy. Defaults to 0 (unlimited). In bytes per second. (Since 3.0) 'max-cpu-throttle: int' (optional) maximum cpu throttle percentage. The default value is 99. (Since 3.1) 'tls-authz: StrOrNull' (optional) Not documented Since: 2.4 -- Command: migrate-set-parameters Set various migration parameters. Arguments: the members of 'MigrateSetParameters' Since: 2.4 Example: -> { "execute": "migrate-set-parameters" , "arguments": { "compress-level": 1 } } -- Object: MigrationParameters The optional members aren't actually optional. Members: 'announce-initial: int' (optional) Initial delay (in milliseconds) before sending the first announce (Since 4.0) 'announce-max: int' (optional) Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the announcement (Since 4.0) 'announce-rounds: int' (optional) Number of self-announce packets sent after migration (Since 4.0) 'announce-step: int' (optional) Increase in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent packets in the announcement (Since 4.0) 'compress-level: int' (optional) compression level 'compress-threads: int' (optional) compression thread count 'compress-wait-thread: boolean' (optional) Controls behavior when all compression threads are currently busy. If true (default), wait for a free compression thread to become available; otherwise, send the page uncompressed. (Since 3.1) 'decompress-threads: int' (optional) decompression thread count 'cpu-throttle-initial: int' (optional) Initial percentage of time guest cpus are throttled when migration auto-converge is activated. (Since 2.7) 'cpu-throttle-increment: int' (optional) throttle percentage increase each time auto-converge detects that migration is not making progress. (Since 2.7) 'tls-creds: string' (optional) ID of the 'tls-creds' object that provides credentials for establishing a TLS connection over the migration data channel. On the outgoing side of the migration, the credentials must be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the incoming side the credentials must be for a 'server' endpoint. An empty string means that QEMU will use plain text mode for migration, rather than TLS (Since 2.7) Note: 2.8 reports this by omitting tls-creds instead. 'tls-hostname: string' (optional) hostname of the target host for the migration. This is required when using x509 based TLS credentials and the migration URI does not already include a hostname. For example if using fd: or exec: based migration, the hostname must be provided so that the server's x509 certificate identity can be validated. (Since 2.7) An empty string means that QEMU will use the hostname associated with the migration URI, if any. (Since 2.9) Note: 2.8 reports this by omitting tls-hostname instead. 'tls-authz: string' (optional) ID of the 'authz' object subclass that provides access control checking of the TLS x509 certificate distinguished name. (Since 4.0) 'max-bandwidth: int' (optional) to set maximum speed for migration. maximum speed in bytes per second. (Since 2.8) 'downtime-limit: int' (optional) set maximum tolerated downtime for migration. maximum downtime in milliseconds (Since 2.8) 'x-checkpoint-delay: int' (optional) the delay time between two COLO checkpoints. (Since 2.8) 'block-incremental: boolean' (optional) Affects how much storage is migrated when the block migration capability is enabled. When false, the entire storage backing chain is migrated into a flattened image at the destination; when true, only the active qcow2 layer is migrated and the destination must already have access to the same backing chain as was used on the source. (since 2.10) 'multifd-channels: int' (optional) Number of channels used to migrate data in parallel. This is the same number that the number of sockets used for migration. The default value is 2 (since 4.0) 'xbzrle-cache-size: int' (optional) cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration. It needs to be a multiple of the target page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11) 'max-postcopy-bandwidth: int' (optional) Background transfer bandwidth during postcopy. Defaults to 0 (unlimited). In bytes per second. (Since 3.0) 'max-cpu-throttle: int' (optional) maximum cpu throttle percentage. Defaults to 99. (Since 3.1) Since: 2.4 -- Command: query-migrate-parameters Returns information about the current migration parameters Returns: 'MigrationParameters' Since: 2.4 Example: -> { "execute": "query-migrate-parameters" } <- { "return": { "decompress-threads": 2, "cpu-throttle-increment": 10, "compress-threads": 8, "compress-level": 1, "cpu-throttle-initial": 20, "max-bandwidth": 33554432, "downtime-limit": 300 } } -- Command: client_migrate_info Set migration information for remote display. This makes the server ask the client to automatically reconnect using the new parameters once migration finished successfully. Only implemented for SPICE. Arguments: 'protocol: string' must be "spice" 'hostname: string' migration target hostname 'port: int' (optional) spice tcp port for plaintext channels 'tls-port: int' (optional) spice tcp port for tls-secured channels 'cert-subject: string' (optional) server certificate subject Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "client_migrate_info", "arguments": { "protocol": "spice", "hostname": "virt42.lab.kraxel.org", "port": 1234 } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: migrate-start-postcopy Followup to a migration command to switch the migration to postcopy mode. The postcopy-ram capability must be set on both source and destination before the original migration command. Since: 2.5 Example: -> { "execute": "migrate-start-postcopy" } <- { "return": {} } -- Event: MIGRATION Emitted when a migration event happens Arguments: 'status: MigrationStatus' 'MigrationStatus' describing the current migration status. Since: 2.4 Example: <- {"timestamp": {"seconds": 1432121972, "microseconds": 744001}, "event": "MIGRATION", "data": {"status": "completed"} } -- Event: MIGRATION_PASS Emitted from the source side of a migration at the start of each pass (when it syncs the dirty bitmap) Arguments: 'pass: int' An incrementing count (starting at 1 on the first pass) Since: 2.6 Example: { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1449669631, "microseconds": 239225}, "event": "MIGRATION_PASS", "data": {"pass": 2} } -- Enum: COLOMessage The message transmission between Primary side and Secondary side. Values: 'checkpoint-ready' Secondary VM (SVM) is ready for checkpointing 'checkpoint-request' Primary VM (PVM) tells SVM to prepare for checkpointing 'checkpoint-reply' SVM gets PVM's checkpoint request 'vmstate-send' VM's state will be sent by PVM. 'vmstate-size' The total size of VMstate. 'vmstate-received' VM's state has been received by SVM. 'vmstate-loaded' VM's state has been loaded by SVM. Since: 2.8 -- Enum: COLOMode The COLO current mode. Values: 'none' COLO is disabled. 'primary' COLO node in primary side. 'secondary' COLO node in slave side. Since: 2.8 -- Enum: FailoverStatus An enumeration of COLO failover status Values: 'none' no failover has ever happened 'require' got failover requirement but not handled 'active' in the process of doing failover 'completed' finish the process of failover 'relaunch' restart the failover process, from 'none' -> 'completed' (Since 2.9) Since: 2.8 -- Event: COLO_EXIT Emitted when VM finishes COLO mode due to some errors happening or at the request of users. Arguments: 'mode: COLOMode' report COLO mode when COLO exited. 'reason: COLOExitReason' describes the reason for the COLO exit. Since: 3.1 Example: <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 2032141960, "microseconds": 417172}, "event": "COLO_EXIT", "data": {"mode": "primary", "reason": "request" } } -- Enum: COLOExitReason The reason for a COLO exit. Values: 'none' failover has never happened. This state does not occur in the COLO_EXIT event, and is only visible in the result of query-colo-status. 'request' COLO exit is due to an external request. 'error' COLO exit is due to an internal error. 'processing' COLO is currently handling a failover (since 4.0). Since: 3.1 -- Command: x-colo-lost-heartbeat Tell qemu that heartbeat is lost, request it to do takeover procedures. If this command is sent to the PVM, the Primary side will exit COLO mode. If sent to the Secondary, the Secondary side will run failover work, then takes over server operation to become the service VM. Since: 2.8 Example: -> { "execute": "x-colo-lost-heartbeat" } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: migrate_cancel Cancel the current executing migration process. Returns: nothing on success Notes: This command succeeds even if there is no migration process running. Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "migrate_cancel" } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: migrate-continue Continue migration when it's in a paused state. Arguments: 'state: MigrationStatus' The state the migration is currently expected to be in Returns: nothing on success Since: 2.11 Example: -> { "execute": "migrate-continue" , "arguments": { "state": "pre-switchover" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: migrate_set_downtime Set maximum tolerated downtime for migration. Arguments: 'value: number' maximum downtime in seconds Returns: nothing on success Notes: This command is deprecated in favor of 'migrate-set-parameters' Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "migrate_set_downtime", "arguments": { "value": 0.1 } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: migrate_set_speed Set maximum speed for migration. Arguments: 'value: int' maximum speed in bytes per second. Returns: nothing on success Notes: This command is deprecated in favor of 'migrate-set-parameters' Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "migrate_set_speed", "arguments": { "value": 1024 } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: migrate-set-cache-size Set cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration Arguments: 'value: int' cache size in bytes The size will be rounded down to the nearest power of 2. The cache size can be modified before and during ongoing migration Returns: nothing on success Notes: This command is deprecated in favor of 'migrate-set-parameters' Since: 1.2 Example: -> { "execute": "migrate-set-cache-size", "arguments": { "value": 536870912 } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: query-migrate-cache-size Query migration XBZRLE cache size Returns: XBZRLE cache size in bytes Notes: This command is deprecated in favor of 'query-migrate-parameters' Since: 1.2 Example: -> { "execute": "query-migrate-cache-size" } <- { "return": 67108864 } -- Command: migrate Migrates the current running guest to another Virtual Machine. Arguments: 'uri: string' the Uniform Resource Identifier of the destination VM 'blk: boolean' (optional) do block migration (full disk copy) 'inc: boolean' (optional) incremental disk copy migration 'detach: boolean' (optional) this argument exists only for compatibility reasons and is ignored by QEMU 'resume: boolean' (optional) resume one paused migration, default "off". (since 3.0) Returns: nothing on success Since: 0.14.0 Notes: 1. The 'query-migrate' command should be used to check migration's progress and final result (this information is provided by the 'status' member) 2. All boolean arguments default to false 3. The user Monitor's "detach" argument is invalid in QMP and should not be used Example: -> { "execute": "migrate", "arguments": { "uri": "tcp:0:4446" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: migrate-incoming Start an incoming migration, the qemu must have been started with -incoming defer Arguments: 'uri: string' The Uniform Resource Identifier identifying the source or address to listen on Returns: nothing on success Since: 2.3 Notes: 1. It's a bad idea to use a string for the uri, but it needs to stay compatible with -incoming and the format of the uri is already exposed above libvirt. 2. QEMU must be started with -incoming defer to allow migrate-incoming to be used. 3. The uri format is the same as for -incoming Example: -> { "execute": "migrate-incoming", "arguments": { "uri": "tcp::4446" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: xen-save-devices-state Save the state of all devices to file. The RAM and the block devices of the VM are not saved by this command. Arguments: 'filename: string' the file to save the state of the devices to as binary data. See xen-save-devices-state.txt for a description of the binary format. 'live: boolean' (optional) Optional argument to ask QEMU to treat this command as part of a live migration. Default to true. (since 2.11) Returns: Nothing on success Since: 1.1 Example: -> { "execute": "xen-save-devices-state", "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/save" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: xen-set-replication Enable or disable replication. Arguments: 'enable: boolean' true to enable, false to disable. 'primary: boolean' true for primary or false for secondary. 'failover: boolean' (optional) true to do failover, false to stop. but cannot be specified if 'enable' is true. default value is false. Returns: nothing. Example: -> { "execute": "xen-set-replication", "arguments": {"enable": true, "primary": false} } <- { "return": {} } Since: 2.9 If: 'defined(CONFIG_REPLICATION)' -- Object: ReplicationStatus The result format for 'query-xen-replication-status'. Members: 'error: boolean' true if an error happened, false if replication is normal. 'desc: string' (optional) the human readable error description string, when 'error' is 'true'. Since: 2.9 If: 'defined(CONFIG_REPLICATION)' -- Command: query-xen-replication-status Query replication status while the vm is running. Returns: A 'ReplicationResult' object showing the status. Example: -> { "execute": "query-xen-replication-status" } <- { "return": { "error": false } } Since: 2.9 If: 'defined(CONFIG_REPLICATION)' -- Command: xen-colo-do-checkpoint Xen uses this command to notify replication to trigger a checkpoint. Returns: nothing. Example: -> { "execute": "xen-colo-do-checkpoint" } <- { "return": {} } Since: 2.9 If: 'defined(CONFIG_REPLICATION)' -- Object: COLOStatus The result format for 'query-colo-status'. Members: 'mode: COLOMode' COLO running mode. If COLO is running, this field will return 'primary' or 'secondary'. 'last-mode: COLOMode' COLO last running mode. If COLO is running, this field will return same like mode field, after failover we can use this field to get last colo mode. (since 4.0) 'reason: COLOExitReason' describes the reason for the COLO exit. Since: 3.1 -- Command: query-colo-status Query COLO status while the vm is running. Returns: A 'COLOStatus' object showing the status. Example: -> { "execute": "query-colo-status" } <- { "return": { "mode": "primary", "reason": "request" } } Since: 3.1 -- Command: migrate-recover Provide a recovery migration stream URI. Arguments: 'uri: string' the URI to be used for the recovery of migration stream. Returns: nothing. Example: -> { "execute": "migrate-recover", "arguments": { "uri": "tcp:192.168.1.200:12345" } } <- { "return": {} } Since: 3.0 -- Command: migrate-pause Pause a migration. Currently it only supports postcopy. Returns: nothing. Example: -> { "execute": "migrate-pause" } <- { "return": {} } Since: 3.0 1.17 Transactions ================= -- Object: Abort This action can be used to test transaction failure. Since: 1.6 -- Enum: ActionCompletionMode An enumeration of Transactional completion modes. Values: 'individual' Do not attempt to cancel any other Actions if any Actions fail after the Transaction request succeeds. All Actions that can complete successfully will do so without waiting on others. This is the default. 'grouped' If any Action fails after the Transaction succeeds, cancel all Actions. Actions do not complete until all Actions are ready to complete. May be rejected by Actions that do not support this completion mode. Since: 2.5 -- Object: TransactionAction A discriminated record of operations that can be performed with 'transaction'. Action 'type' can be: - 'abort': since 1.6 - 'block-dirty-bitmap-add': since 2.5 - 'block-dirty-bitmap-clear': since 2.5 - 'block-dirty-bitmap-enable': since 4.0 - 'block-dirty-bitmap-disable': since 4.0 - 'block-dirty-bitmap-merge': since 4.0 - 'blockdev-backup': since 2.3 - 'blockdev-snapshot': since 2.5 - 'blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync': since 1.7 - 'blockdev-snapshot-sync': since 1.1 - 'drive-backup': since 1.6 Members: 'type' One of "abort", "block-dirty-bitmap-add", "block-dirty-bitmap-clear", "block-dirty-bitmap-enable", "block-dirty-bitmap-disable", "block-dirty-bitmap-merge", "blockdev-backup", "blockdev-snapshot", "blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync", "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "drive-backup" 'data: Abort' when 'type' is "abort" 'data: BlockDirtyBitmapAdd' when 'type' is "block-dirty-bitmap-add" 'data: BlockDirtyBitmap' when 'type' is "block-dirty-bitmap-clear" 'data: BlockDirtyBitmap' when 'type' is "block-dirty-bitmap-enable" 'data: BlockDirtyBitmap' when 'type' is "block-dirty-bitmap-disable" 'data: BlockDirtyBitmapMerge' when 'type' is "block-dirty-bitmap-merge" 'data: BlockdevBackup' when 'type' is "blockdev-backup" 'data: BlockdevSnapshot' when 'type' is "blockdev-snapshot" 'data: BlockdevSnapshotInternal' when 'type' is "blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync" 'data: BlockdevSnapshotSync' when 'type' is "blockdev-snapshot-sync" 'data: DriveBackup' when 'type' is "drive-backup" Since: 1.1 -- Object: TransactionProperties Optional arguments to modify the behavior of a Transaction. Members: 'completion-mode: ActionCompletionMode' (optional) Controls how jobs launched asynchronously by Actions will complete or fail as a group. See 'ActionCompletionMode' for details. Since: 2.5 -- Command: transaction Executes a number of transactionable QMP commands atomically. If any operation fails, then the entire set of actions will be abandoned and the appropriate error returned. For external snapshots, the dictionary contains the device, the file to use for the new snapshot, and the format. The default format, if not specified, is qcow2. Each new snapshot defaults to being created by QEMU (wiping any contents if the file already exists), but it is also possible to reuse an externally-created file. In the latter case, you should ensure that the new image file has the same contents as the current one; QEMU cannot perform any meaningful check. Typically this is achieved by using the current image file as the backing file for the new image. On failure, the original disks pre-snapshot attempt will be used. For internal snapshots, the dictionary contains the device and the snapshot's name. If an internal snapshot matching name already exists, the request will be rejected. Only some image formats support it, for example, qcow2, rbd, and sheepdog. On failure, qemu will try delete the newly created internal snapshot in the transaction. When an I/O error occurs during deletion, the user needs to fix it later with qemu-img or other command. Arguments: 'actions: array of TransactionAction' List of 'TransactionAction'; information needed for the respective operations. 'properties: TransactionProperties' (optional) structure of additional options to control the execution of the transaction. See 'TransactionProperties' for additional detail. Returns: nothing on success Errors depend on the operations of the transaction Note: The transaction aborts on the first failure. Therefore, there will be information on only one failed operation returned in an error condition, and subsequent actions will not have been attempted. Since: 1.1 Example: -> { "execute": "transaction", "arguments": { "actions": [ { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "data" : { "device": "ide-hd0", "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image", "format": "qcow2" } }, { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "data" : { "node-name": "myfile", "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image2", "snapshot-node-name": "node3432", "mode": "existing", "format": "qcow2" } }, { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "data" : { "device": "ide-hd1", "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image2", "mode": "existing", "format": "qcow2" } }, { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync", "data" : { "device": "ide-hd2", "name": "snapshot0" } } ] } } <- { "return": {} } 1.18 Tracing ============ -- Enum: TraceEventState State of a tracing event. Values: 'unavailable' The event is statically disabled. 'disabled' The event is dynamically disabled. 'enabled' The event is dynamically enabled. Since: 2.2 -- Object: TraceEventInfo Information of a tracing event. Members: 'name: string' Event name. 'state: TraceEventState' Tracing state. 'vcpu: boolean' Whether this is a per-vCPU event (since 2.7). An event is per-vCPU if it has the "vcpu" property in the "trace-events" files. Since: 2.2 -- Command: trace-event-get-state Query the state of events. Arguments: 'name: string' Event name pattern (case-sensitive glob). 'vcpu: int' (optional) The vCPU to query (any by default; since 2.7). Returns: a list of 'TraceEventInfo' for the matching events An event is returned if: - its name matches the 'name' pattern, and - if 'vcpu' is given, the event has the "vcpu" property. Therefore, if 'vcpu' is given, the operation will only match per-vCPU events, returning their state on the specified vCPU. Special case: if 'name' is an exact match, 'vcpu' is given and the event does not have the "vcpu" property, an error is returned. Since: 2.2 Example: -> { "execute": "trace-event-get-state", "arguments": { "name": "qemu_memalign" } } <- { "return": [ { "name": "qemu_memalign", "state": "disabled" } ] } -- Command: trace-event-set-state Set the dynamic tracing state of events. Arguments: 'name: string' Event name pattern (case-sensitive glob). 'enable: boolean' Whether to enable tracing. 'ignore-unavailable: boolean' (optional) Do not match unavailable events with 'name'. 'vcpu: int' (optional) The vCPU to act upon (all by default; since 2.7). An event's state is modified if: - its name matches the 'name' pattern, and - if 'vcpu' is given, the event has the "vcpu" property. Therefore, if 'vcpu' is given, the operation will only match per-vCPU events, setting their state on the specified vCPU. Special case: if 'name' is an exact match, 'vcpu' is given and the event does not have the "vcpu" property, an error is returned. Since: 2.2 Example: -> { "execute": "trace-event-set-state", "arguments": { "name": "qemu_memalign", "enable": "true" } } <- { "return": {} } 1.19 QMP introspection ====================== -- Command: query-qmp-schema Command query-qmp-schema exposes the QMP wire ABI as an array of SchemaInfo. This lets QMP clients figure out what commands and events are available in this QEMU, and their parameters and results. However, the SchemaInfo can't reflect all the rules and restrictions that apply to QMP. It's interface introspection (figuring out what's there), not interface specification. The specification is in the QAPI schema. Furthermore, while we strive to keep the QMP wire format backwards-compatible across qemu versions, the introspection output is not guaranteed to have the same stability. For example, one version of qemu may list an object member as an optional non-variant, while another lists the same member only through the object's variants; or the type of a member may change from a generic string into a specific enum or from one specific type into an alternate that includes the original type alongside something else. Returns: array of 'SchemaInfo', where each element describes an entity in the ABI: command, event, type, ... The order of the various SchemaInfo is unspecified; however, all names are guaranteed to be unique (no name will be duplicated with different meta-types). Note: the QAPI schema is also used to help define *internal* interfaces, by defining QAPI types. These are not part of the QMP wire ABI, and therefore not returned by this command. Since: 2.5 -- Enum: SchemaMetaType This is a 'SchemaInfo''s meta type, i.e. the kind of entity it describes. Values: 'builtin' a predefined type such as 'int' or 'bool'. 'enum' an enumeration type 'array' an array type 'object' an object type (struct or union) 'alternate' an alternate type 'command' a QMP command 'event' a QMP event Since: 2.5 -- Object: SchemaInfo Members: 'name: string' the entity's name, inherited from 'base'. The SchemaInfo is always referenced by this name. Commands and events have the name defined in the QAPI schema. Unlike command and event names, type names are not part of the wire ABI. Consequently, type names are meaningless strings here, although they are still guaranteed unique regardless of 'meta-type'. 'meta-type: SchemaMetaType' the entity's meta type, inherited from 'base'. The members of 'SchemaInfoBuiltin' when 'meta-type' is "builtin" The members of 'SchemaInfoEnum' when 'meta-type' is "enum" The members of 'SchemaInfoArray' when 'meta-type' is "array" The members of 'SchemaInfoObject' when 'meta-type' is "object" The members of 'SchemaInfoAlternate' when 'meta-type' is "alternate" The members of 'SchemaInfoCommand' when 'meta-type' is "command" The members of 'SchemaInfoEvent' when 'meta-type' is "event" Additional members depend on the value of 'meta-type'. Since: 2.5 -- Object: SchemaInfoBuiltin Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'builtin'. Members: 'json-type: JSONType' the JSON type used for this type on the wire. Since: 2.5 -- Enum: JSONType The four primitive and two structured types according to RFC 8259 section 1, plus 'int' (split off 'number'), plus the obvious top type 'value'. Values: 'string' Not documented 'number' Not documented 'int' Not documented 'boolean' Not documented 'null' Not documented 'object' Not documented 'array' Not documented 'value' Not documented Since: 2.5 -- Object: SchemaInfoEnum Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'enum'. Members: 'values: array of string' the enumeration type's values, in no particular order. Values of this type are JSON string on the wire. Since: 2.5 -- Object: SchemaInfoArray Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'array'. Members: 'element-type: string' the array type's element type. Values of this type are JSON array on the wire. Since: 2.5 -- Object: SchemaInfoObject Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'object'. Members: 'members: array of SchemaInfoObjectMember' the object type's (non-variant) members, in no particular order. 'tag: string' (optional) the name of the member serving as type tag. An element of 'members' with this name must exist. 'variants: array of SchemaInfoObjectVariant' (optional) variant members, i.e. additional members that depend on the type tag's value. Present exactly when 'tag' is present. The variants are in no particular order, and may even differ from the order of the values of the enum type of the 'tag'. 'features: array of string' (optional) names of features associated with the type, in no particular order. (since: 4.1) Values of this type are JSON object on the wire. Since: 2.5 -- Object: SchemaInfoObjectMember An object member. Members: 'name: string' the member's name, as defined in the QAPI schema. 'type: string' the name of the member's type. 'default: value' (optional) default when used as command parameter. If absent, the parameter is mandatory. If present, the value must be null. The parameter is optional, and behavior when it's missing is not specified here. Future extension: if present and non-null, the parameter is optional, and defaults to this value. Since: 2.5 -- Object: SchemaInfoObjectVariant The variant members for a value of the type tag. Members: 'case: string' a value of the type tag. 'type: string' the name of the object type that provides the variant members when the type tag has value 'case'. Since: 2.5 -- Object: SchemaInfoAlternate Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'alternate'. Members: 'members: array of SchemaInfoAlternateMember' the alternate type's members, in no particular order. The members' wire encoding is distinct, see docs/devel/qapi-code-gen.txt section Alternate types. On the wire, this can be any of the members. Since: 2.5 -- Object: SchemaInfoAlternateMember An alternate member. Members: 'type: string' the name of the member's type. Since: 2.5 -- Object: SchemaInfoCommand Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'command'. Members: 'arg-type: string' the name of the object type that provides the command's parameters. 'ret-type: string' the name of the command's result type. 'allow-oob: boolean' (optional) whether the command allows out-of-band execution, defaults to false (Since: 2.12) TODO: 'success-response' (currently irrelevant, because it's QGA, not QMP) Since: 2.5 -- Object: SchemaInfoEvent Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'event'. Members: 'arg-type: string' the name of the object type that provides the event's parameters. Since: 2.5 1.20 QEMU Object Model (QOM) ============================ -- Object: ObjectPropertyInfo Members: 'name: string' the name of the property 'type: string' the type of the property. This will typically come in one of four forms: 1) A primitive type such as 'u8', 'u16', 'bool', 'str', or 'double'. These types are mapped to the appropriate JSON type. 2) A child type in the form 'child' where subtype is a qdev device type name. Child properties create the composition tree. 3) A link type in the form 'link' where subtype is a qdev device type name. Link properties form the device model graph. 'description: string' (optional) if specified, the description of the property. Since: 1.2 -- Command: qom-list This command will list any properties of a object given a path in the object model. Arguments: 'path: string' the path within the object model. See 'qom-get' for a description of this parameter. Returns: a list of 'ObjectPropertyInfo' that describe the properties of the object. Since: 1.2 Example: -> { "execute": "qom-list", "arguments": { "path": "/chardevs" } } <- { "return": [ { "name": "type", "type": "string" }, { "name": "parallel0", "type": "child" }, { "name": "serial0", "type": "child" }, { "name": "mon0", "type": "child" } ] } -- Command: qom-get This command will get a property from a object model path and return the value. Arguments: 'path: string' The path within the object model. There are two forms of supported paths-absolute and partial paths. Absolute paths are derived from the root object and can follow child<> or link<> properties. Since they can follow link<> properties, they can be arbitrarily long. Absolute paths look like absolute filenames and are prefixed with a leading slash. Partial paths look like relative filenames. They do not begin with a prefix. The matching rules for partial paths are subtle but designed to make specifying objects easy. At each level of the composition tree, the partial path is matched as an absolute path. The first match is not returned. At least two matches are searched for. A successful result is only returned if only one match is found. If more than one match is found, a flag is return to indicate that the match was ambiguous. 'property: string' The property name to read Returns: The property value. The type depends on the property type. child<> and link<> properties are returned as #str pathnames. All integer property types (u8, u16, etc) are returned as #int. Since: 1.2 Example: 1. Use absolute path -> { "execute": "qom-get", "arguments": { "path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]", "property": "hotplugged" } } <- { "return": false } 2. Use partial path -> { "execute": "qom-get", "arguments": { "path": "unattached/sysbus", "property": "type" } } <- { "return": "System" } -- Command: qom-set This command will set a property from a object model path. Arguments: 'path: string' see 'qom-get' for a description of this parameter 'property: string' the property name to set 'value: value' a value who's type is appropriate for the property type. See 'qom-get' for a description of type mapping. Since: 1.2 Example: -> { "execute": "qom-set", "arguments": { "path": "/machine", "property": "graphics", "value": false } } <- { "return": {} } -- Object: ObjectTypeInfo This structure describes a search result from 'qom-list-types' Members: 'name: string' the type name found in the search 'abstract: boolean' (optional) the type is abstract and can't be directly instantiated. Omitted if false. (since 2.10) 'parent: string' (optional) Name of parent type, if any (since 2.10) Since: 1.1 -- Command: qom-list-types This command will return a list of types given search parameters Arguments: 'implements: string' (optional) if specified, only return types that implement this type name 'abstract: boolean' (optional) if true, include abstract types in the results Returns: a list of 'ObjectTypeInfo' or an empty list if no results are found Since: 1.1 -- Command: qom-list-properties List properties associated with a QOM object. Arguments: 'typename: string' the type name of an object Note: objects can create properties at runtime, for example to describe links between different devices and/or objects. These properties are not included in the output of this command. Returns: a list of ObjectPropertyInfo describing object properties Since: 2.12 -- Command: object-add Create a QOM object. Arguments: 'qom-type: string' the class name for the object to be created 'id: string' the name of the new object 'props: value' (optional) a dictionary of properties to be passed to the backend Returns: Nothing on success Error if 'qom-type' is not a valid class name Since: 2.0 Example: -> { "execute": "object-add", "arguments": { "qom-type": "rng-random", "id": "rng1", "props": { "filename": "/dev/hwrng" } } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: object-del Remove a QOM object. Arguments: 'id: string' the name of the QOM object to remove Returns: Nothing on success Error if 'id' is not a valid id for a QOM object Since: 2.0 Example: -> { "execute": "object-del", "arguments": { "id": "rng1" } } <- { "return": {} } 1.21 Device infrastructure (qdev) ================================= -- Command: device-list-properties List properties associated with a device. Arguments: 'typename: string' the type name of a device Returns: a list of ObjectPropertyInfo describing a devices properties Note: objects can create properties at runtime, for example to describe links between different devices and/or objects. These properties are not included in the output of this command. Since: 1.2 -- Command: device_add Arguments: 'driver: string' the name of the new device's driver 'bus: string' (optional) the device's parent bus (device tree path) 'id: string' (optional) the device's ID, must be unique Additional arguments depend on the type. Add a device. Notes: 1. For detailed information about this command, please refer to the 'docs/qdev-device-use.txt' file. 2. It's possible to list device properties by running QEMU with the "-device DEVICE,help" command-line argument, where DEVICE is the device's name Example: -> { "execute": "device_add", "arguments": { "driver": "e1000", "id": "net1", "bus": "pci.0", "mac": "52:54:00:12:34:56" } } <- { "return": {} } TODO: This command effectively bypasses QAPI completely due to its "additional arguments" business. It shouldn't have been added to the schema in this form. It should be qapified properly, or replaced by a properly qapified command. Since: 0.13 -- Command: device_del Remove a device from a guest Arguments: 'id: string' the device's ID or QOM path Returns: Nothing on success If 'id' is not a valid device, DeviceNotFound Notes: When this command completes, the device may not be removed from the guest. Hot removal is an operation that requires guest cooperation. This command merely requests that the guest begin the hot removal process. Completion of the device removal process is signaled with a DEVICE_DELETED event. Guest reset will automatically complete removal for all devices. Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "device_del", "arguments": { "id": "net1" } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "device_del", "arguments": { "id": "/machine/peripheral-anon/device[0]" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Event: DEVICE_DELETED Emitted whenever the device removal completion is acknowledged by the guest. At this point, it's safe to reuse the specified device ID. Device removal can be initiated by the guest or by HMP/QMP commands. Arguments: 'device: string' (optional) device name 'path: string' device path Since: 1.5 Example: <- { "event": "DEVICE_DELETED", "data": { "device": "virtio-net-pci-0", "path": "/machine/peripheral/virtio-net-pci-0" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } 1.22 Machines ============= -- Enum: CpuInfoArch An enumeration of cpu types that enable additional information during 'query-cpus' and 'query-cpus-fast'. Values: 's390' since 2.12 'riscv' since 2.12 'x86' Not documented 'sparc' Not documented 'ppc' Not documented 'mips' Not documented 'tricore' Not documented 'other' Not documented Since: 2.6 -- Object: CpuInfo Information about a virtual CPU Members: 'CPU: int' the index of the virtual CPU 'current: boolean' this only exists for backwards compatibility and should be ignored 'halted: boolean' true if the virtual CPU is in the halt state. Halt usually refers to a processor specific low power mode. 'qom_path: string' path to the CPU object in the QOM tree (since 2.4) 'thread_id: int' ID of the underlying host thread 'props: CpuInstanceProperties' (optional) properties describing to which node/socket/core/thread virtual CPU belongs to, provided if supported by board (since 2.10) 'arch: CpuInfoArch' architecture of the cpu, which determines which additional fields will be listed (since 2.6) The members of 'CpuInfoX86' when 'arch' is "x86" The members of 'CpuInfoSPARC' when 'arch' is "sparc" The members of 'CpuInfoPPC' when 'arch' is "ppc" The members of 'CpuInfoMIPS' when 'arch' is "mips" The members of 'CpuInfoTricore' when 'arch' is "tricore" The members of 'CpuInfoS390' when 'arch' is "s390" The members of 'CpuInfoRISCV' when 'arch' is "riscv" Since: 0.14.0 Notes: 'halted' is a transient state that changes frequently. By the time the data is sent to the client, the guest may no longer be halted. -- Object: CpuInfoX86 Additional information about a virtual i386 or x86_64 CPU Members: 'pc: int' the 64-bit instruction pointer Since: 2.6 -- Object: CpuInfoSPARC Additional information about a virtual SPARC CPU Members: 'pc: int' the PC component of the instruction pointer 'npc: int' the NPC component of the instruction pointer Since: 2.6 -- Object: CpuInfoPPC Additional information about a virtual PPC CPU Members: 'nip: int' the instruction pointer Since: 2.6 -- Object: CpuInfoMIPS Additional information about a virtual MIPS CPU Members: 'PC: int' the instruction pointer Since: 2.6 -- Object: CpuInfoTricore Additional information about a virtual Tricore CPU Members: 'PC: int' the instruction pointer Since: 2.6 -- Object: CpuInfoRISCV Additional information about a virtual RISCV CPU Members: 'pc: int' the instruction pointer Since 2.12 -- Enum: CpuS390State An enumeration of cpu states that can be assumed by a virtual S390 CPU Values: 'uninitialized' Not documented 'stopped' Not documented 'check-stop' Not documented 'operating' Not documented 'load' Not documented Since: 2.12 -- Object: CpuInfoS390 Additional information about a virtual S390 CPU Members: 'cpu-state: CpuS390State' the virtual CPU's state Since: 2.12 -- Command: query-cpus Returns a list of information about each virtual CPU. This command causes vCPU threads to exit to userspace, which causes a small interruption to guest CPU execution. This will have a negative impact on realtime guests and other latency sensitive guest workloads. It is recommended to use 'query-cpus-fast' instead of this command to avoid the vCPU interruption. Returns: a list of 'CpuInfo' for each virtual CPU Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-cpus" } <- { "return": [ { "CPU":0, "current":true, "halted":false, "qom_path":"/machine/unattached/device[0]", "arch":"x86", "pc":3227107138, "thread_id":3134 }, { "CPU":1, "current":false, "halted":true, "qom_path":"/machine/unattached/device[2]", "arch":"x86", "pc":7108165, "thread_id":3135 } ] } Notes: This interface is deprecated (since 2.12.0), and it is strongly recommended that you avoid using it. Use 'query-cpus-fast' to obtain information about virtual CPUs. -- Object: CpuInfoFast Information about a virtual CPU Members: 'cpu-index: int' index of the virtual CPU 'qom-path: string' path to the CPU object in the QOM tree 'thread-id: int' ID of the underlying host thread 'props: CpuInstanceProperties' (optional) properties describing to which node/socket/core/thread virtual CPU belongs to, provided if supported by board 'arch: CpuInfoArch' base architecture of the cpu; deprecated since 3.0.0 in favor of 'target' 'target: SysEmuTarget' the QEMU system emulation target, which determines which additional fields will be listed (since 3.0) The members of 'CpuInfoS390' when 'target' is "s390x" Since: 2.12 -- Command: query-cpus-fast Returns information about all virtual CPUs. This command does not incur a performance penalty and should be used in production instead of query-cpus. Returns: list of 'CpuInfoFast' Since: 2.12 Example: -> { "execute": "query-cpus-fast" } <- { "return": [ { "thread-id": 25627, "props": { "core-id": 0, "thread-id": 0, "socket-id": 0 }, "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]", "arch":"x86", "target":"x86_64", "cpu-index": 0 }, { "thread-id": 25628, "props": { "core-id": 0, "thread-id": 0, "socket-id": 1 }, "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[2]", "arch":"x86", "target":"x86_64", "cpu-index": 1 } ] } -- Command: cpu-add Adds CPU with specified ID. Arguments: 'id: int' ID of CPU to be created, valid values [0..max_cpus) Returns: Nothing on success Since: 1.5 Note: This command is deprecated. The 'device_add' command should be used instead. See the 'query-hotpluggable-cpus' command for details. Example: -> { "execute": "cpu-add", "arguments": { "id": 2 } } <- { "return": {} } -- Object: MachineInfo Information describing a machine. Members: 'name: string' the name of the machine 'alias: string' (optional) an alias for the machine name 'is-default: boolean' (optional) whether the machine is default 'cpu-max: int' maximum number of CPUs supported by the machine type (since 1.5.0) 'hotpluggable-cpus: boolean' cpu hotplug via -device is supported (since 2.7.0) 'numa-mem-supported: boolean' true if '-numa node,mem' option is supported by the machine type and false otherwise (since 4.1) 'deprecated: boolean' if true, the machine type is deprecated and may be removed in future versions of QEMU according to the QEMU deprecation policy (since 4.1.0) Since: 1.2.0 -- Command: query-machines Return a list of supported machines Returns: a list of MachineInfo Since: 1.2.0 -- Object: CurrentMachineParams Information describing the running machine parameters. Members: 'wakeup-suspend-support: boolean' true if the machine supports wake up from suspend Since: 4.0 -- Command: query-current-machine Return information on the current virtual machine. Returns: CurrentMachineParams Since: 4.0 -- Enum: NumaOptionsType Values: 'node' NUMA nodes configuration 'dist' NUMA distance configuration (since 2.10) 'cpu' property based CPU(s) to node mapping (Since: 2.10) Since: 2.1 -- Object: NumaOptions A discriminated record of NUMA options. (for OptsVisitor) Members: 'type: NumaOptionsType' Not documented The members of 'NumaNodeOptions' when 'type' is "node" The members of 'NumaDistOptions' when 'type' is "dist" The members of 'NumaCpuOptions' when 'type' is "cpu" Since: 2.1 -- Object: NumaNodeOptions Create a guest NUMA node. (for OptsVisitor) Members: 'nodeid: int' (optional) NUMA node ID (increase by 1 from 0 if omitted) 'cpus: array of int' (optional) VCPUs belonging to this node (assign VCPUS round-robin if omitted) 'mem: int' (optional) memory size of this node; mutually exclusive with 'memdev'. Equally divide total memory among nodes if both 'mem' and 'memdev' are omitted. 'memdev: string' (optional) memory backend object. If specified for one node, it must be specified for all nodes. Since: 2.1 -- Object: NumaDistOptions Set the distance between 2 NUMA nodes. Members: 'src: int' source NUMA node. 'dst: int' destination NUMA node. 'val: int' NUMA distance from source node to destination node. When a node is unreachable from another node, set the distance between them to 255. Since: 2.10 -- Enum: X86CPURegister32 A X86 32-bit register Values: 'EAX' Not documented 'EBX' Not documented 'ECX' Not documented 'EDX' Not documented 'ESP' Not documented 'EBP' Not documented 'ESI' Not documented 'EDI' Not documented Since: 1.5 -- Object: X86CPUFeatureWordInfo Information about a X86 CPU feature word Members: 'cpuid-input-eax: int' Input EAX value for CPUID instruction for that feature word 'cpuid-input-ecx: int' (optional) Input ECX value for CPUID instruction for that feature word 'cpuid-register: X86CPURegister32' Output register containing the feature bits 'features: int' value of output register, containing the feature bits Since: 1.5 -- Object: DummyForceArrays Not used by QMP; hack to let us use X86CPUFeatureWordInfoList internally Members: 'unused: array of X86CPUFeatureWordInfo' Not documented Since: 2.5 -- Object: NumaCpuOptions Option "-numa cpu" overrides default cpu to node mapping. It accepts the same set of cpu properties as returned by query-hotpluggable-cpus[].props, where node-id could be used to override default node mapping. Members: The members of 'CpuInstanceProperties' Since: 2.10 -- Enum: HostMemPolicy Host memory policy types Values: 'default' restore default policy, remove any nondefault policy 'preferred' set the preferred host nodes for allocation 'bind' a strict policy that restricts memory allocation to the host nodes specified 'interleave' memory allocations are interleaved across the set of host nodes specified Since: 2.1 -- Object: Memdev Information about memory backend Members: 'id: string' (optional) backend's ID if backend has 'id' property (since 2.9) 'size: int' memory backend size 'merge: boolean' enables or disables memory merge support 'dump: boolean' includes memory backend's memory in a core dump or not 'prealloc: boolean' enables or disables memory preallocation 'host-nodes: array of int' host nodes for its memory policy 'policy: HostMemPolicy' memory policy of memory backend Since: 2.1 -- Command: query-memdev Returns information for all memory backends. Returns: a list of 'Memdev'. Since: 2.1 Example: -> { "execute": "query-memdev" } <- { "return": [ { "id": "mem1", "size": 536870912, "merge": false, "dump": true, "prealloc": false, "host-nodes": [0, 1], "policy": "bind" }, { "size": 536870912, "merge": false, "dump": true, "prealloc": true, "host-nodes": [2, 3], "policy": "preferred" } ] } -- Object: CpuInstanceProperties List of properties to be used for hotplugging a CPU instance, it should be passed by management with device_add command when a CPU is being hotplugged. Members: 'node-id: int' (optional) NUMA node ID the CPU belongs to 'socket-id: int' (optional) socket number within node/board the CPU belongs to 'die-id: int' (optional) die number within node/board the CPU belongs to (Since 4.1) 'core-id: int' (optional) core number within die the CPU belongs to# 'thread-id': thread number within core the CPU belongs to 'thread-id: int' (optional) Not documented Note: currently there are 5 properties that could be present but management should be prepared to pass through other properties with device_add command to allow for future interface extension. This also requires the filed names to be kept in sync with the properties passed to -device/device_add. Since: 2.7 -- Object: HotpluggableCPU Members: 'type: string' CPU object type for usage with device_add command 'props: CpuInstanceProperties' list of properties to be used for hotplugging CPU 'vcpus-count: int' number of logical VCPU threads 'HotpluggableCPU' provides 'qom-path: string' (optional) link to existing CPU object if CPU is present or omitted if CPU is not present. Since: 2.7 -- Command: query-hotpluggable-cpus TODO: Better documentation; currently there is none. Returns: a list of HotpluggableCPU objects. Since: 2.7 Example: For pseries machine type started with -smp 2,cores=2,maxcpus=4 -cpu POWER8: -> { "execute": "query-hotpluggable-cpus" } <- {"return": [ { "props": { "core": 8 }, "type": "POWER8-spapr-cpu-core", "vcpus-count": 1 }, { "props": { "core": 0 }, "type": "POWER8-spapr-cpu-core", "vcpus-count": 1, "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]"} ]}' For pc machine type started with -smp 1,maxcpus=2: -> { "execute": "query-hotpluggable-cpus" } <- {"return": [ { "type": "qemu64-x86_64-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1, "props": {"core-id": 0, "socket-id": 1, "thread-id": 0} }, { "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]", "type": "qemu64-x86_64-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1, "props": {"core-id": 0, "socket-id": 0, "thread-id": 0} } ]} For s390x-virtio-ccw machine type started with -smp 1,maxcpus=2 -cpu qemu (Since: 2.11): -> { "execute": "query-hotpluggable-cpus" } <- {"return": [ { "type": "qemu-s390x-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1, "props": { "core-id": 1 } }, { "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]", "type": "qemu-s390x-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1, "props": { "core-id": 0 } } ]} -- Command: set-numa-node Runtime equivalent of '-numa' CLI option, available at preconfigure stage to configure numa mapping before initializing machine. Since 3.0 Arguments: the members of 'NumaOptions' -- Object: CpuModelInfo Virtual CPU model. A CPU model consists of the name of a CPU definition, to which delta changes are applied (e.g. features added/removed). Most magic values that an architecture might require should be hidden behind the name. However, if required, architectures can expose relevant properties. Members: 'name: string' the name of the CPU definition the model is based on 'props: value' (optional) a dictionary of QOM properties to be applied Since: 2.8.0 -- Enum: CpuModelExpansionType An enumeration of CPU model expansion types. Values: 'static' Expand to a static CPU model, a combination of a static base model name and property delta changes. As the static base model will never change, the expanded CPU model will be the same, independent of QEMU version, machine type, machine options, and accelerator options. Therefore, the resulting model can be used by tooling without having to specify a compatibility machine - e.g. when displaying the "host" model. The 'static' CPU models are migration-safe. 'full' Expand all properties. The produced model is not guaranteed to be migration-safe, but allows tooling to get an insight and work with model details. Note: When a non-migration-safe CPU model is expanded in static mode, some features enabled by the CPU model may be omitted, because they can't be implemented by a static CPU model definition (e.g. cache info passthrough and PMU passthrough in x86). If you need an accurate representation of the features enabled by a non-migration-safe CPU model, use 'full'. If you need a static representation that will keep ABI compatibility even when changing QEMU version or machine-type, use 'static' (but keep in mind that some features may be omitted). Since: 2.8.0 -- Enum: CpuModelCompareResult An enumeration of CPU model comparison results. The result is usually calculated using e.g. CPU features or CPU generations. Values: 'incompatible' If model A is incompatible to model B, model A is not guaranteed to run where model B runs and the other way around. 'identical' If model A is identical to model B, model A is guaranteed to run where model B runs and the other way around. 'superset' If model A is a superset of model B, model B is guaranteed to run where model A runs. There are no guarantees about the other way. 'subset' If model A is a subset of model B, model A is guaranteed to run where model B runs. There are no guarantees about the other way. Since: 2.8.0 -- Object: CpuModelBaselineInfo The result of a CPU model baseline. Members: 'model: CpuModelInfo' the baselined CpuModelInfo. Since: 2.8.0 If: 'defined(TARGET_S390X)' -- Object: CpuModelCompareInfo The result of a CPU model comparison. Members: 'result: CpuModelCompareResult' The result of the compare operation. 'responsible-properties: array of string' List of properties that led to the comparison result not being identical. 'responsible-properties' is a list of QOM property names that led to both CPUs not being detected as identical. For identical models, this list is empty. If a QOM property is read-only, that means there's no known way to make the CPU models identical. If the special property name "type" is included, the models are by definition not identical and cannot be made identical. Since: 2.8.0 If: 'defined(TARGET_S390X)' -- Command: query-cpu-model-comparison Compares two CPU models, returning how they compare in a specific configuration. The results indicates how both models compare regarding runnability. This result can be used by tooling to make decisions if a certain CPU model will run in a certain configuration or if a compatible CPU model has to be created by baselining. Usually, a CPU model is compared against the maximum possible CPU model of a certain configuration (e.g. the "host" model for KVM). If that CPU model is identical or a subset, it will run in that configuration. The result returned by this command may be affected by: * QEMU version: CPU models may look different depending on the QEMU version. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) * machine-type: CPU model may look different depending on the machine-type. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) * machine options (including accelerator): in some architectures, CPU models may look different depending on machine and accelerator options. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) * "-cpu" arguments and global properties: arguments to the -cpu option and global properties may affect expansion of CPU models. Using query-cpu-model-expansion while using these is not advised. Some architectures may not support comparing CPU models. s390x supports comparing CPU models. Arguments: 'modela: CpuModelInfo' Not documented 'modelb: CpuModelInfo' Not documented Returns: a CpuModelBaselineInfo. Returns an error if comparing CPU models is not supported, if a model cannot be used, if a model contains an unknown cpu definition name, unknown properties or properties with wrong types. Note: this command isn't specific to s390x, but is only implemented on this architecture currently. Since: 2.8.0 If: 'defined(TARGET_S390X)' -- Command: query-cpu-model-baseline Baseline two CPU models, creating a compatible third model. The created model will always be a static, migration-safe CPU model (see "static" CPU model expansion for details). This interface can be used by tooling to create a compatible CPU model out two CPU models. The created CPU model will be identical to or a subset of both CPU models when comparing them. Therefore, the created CPU model is guaranteed to run where the given CPU models run. The result returned by this command may be affected by: * QEMU version: CPU models may look different depending on the QEMU version. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) * machine-type: CPU model may look different depending on the machine-type. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) * machine options (including accelerator): in some architectures, CPU models may look different depending on machine and accelerator options. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) * "-cpu" arguments and global properties: arguments to the -cpu option and global properties may affect expansion of CPU models. Using query-cpu-model-expansion while using these is not advised. Some architectures may not support baselining CPU models. s390x supports baselining CPU models. Arguments: 'modela: CpuModelInfo' Not documented 'modelb: CpuModelInfo' Not documented Returns: a CpuModelBaselineInfo. Returns an error if baselining CPU models is not supported, if a model cannot be used, if a model contains an unknown cpu definition name, unknown properties or properties with wrong types. Note: this command isn't specific to s390x, but is only implemented on this architecture currently. Since: 2.8.0 If: 'defined(TARGET_S390X)' -- Object: CpuModelExpansionInfo The result of a cpu model expansion. Members: 'model: CpuModelInfo' the expanded CpuModelInfo. Since: 2.8.0 If: 'defined(TARGET_S390X) || defined(TARGET_I386)' -- Command: query-cpu-model-expansion Expands a given CPU model (or a combination of CPU model + additional options) to different granularities, allowing tooling to get an understanding what a specific CPU model looks like in QEMU under a certain configuration. This interface can be used to query the "host" CPU model. The data returned by this command may be affected by: * QEMU version: CPU models may look different depending on the QEMU version. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) * machine-type: CPU model may look different depending on the machine-type. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) * machine options (including accelerator): in some architectures, CPU models may look different depending on machine and accelerator options. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) * "-cpu" arguments and global properties: arguments to the -cpu option and global properties may affect expansion of CPU models. Using query-cpu-model-expansion while using these is not advised. Some architectures may not support all expansion types. s390x supports "full" and "static". Arguments: 'type: CpuModelExpansionType' Not documented 'model: CpuModelInfo' Not documented Returns: a CpuModelExpansionInfo. Returns an error if expanding CPU models is not supported, if the model cannot be expanded, if the model contains an unknown CPU definition name, unknown properties or properties with a wrong type. Also returns an error if an expansion type is not supported. Since: 2.8.0 If: 'defined(TARGET_S390X) || defined(TARGET_I386)' -- Object: CpuDefinitionInfo Virtual CPU definition. Members: 'name: string' the name of the CPU definition 'migration-safe: boolean' (optional) whether a CPU definition can be safely used for migration in combination with a QEMU compatibility machine when migrating between different QEMU versions and between hosts with different sets of (hardware or software) capabilities. If not provided, information is not available and callers should not assume the CPU definition to be migration-safe. (since 2.8) 'static: boolean' whether a CPU definition is static and will not change depending on QEMU version, machine type, machine options and accelerator options. A static model is always migration-safe. (since 2.8) 'unavailable-features: array of string' (optional) List of properties that prevent the CPU model from running in the current host. (since 2.8) 'typename: string' Type name that can be used as argument to 'device-list-properties', to introspect properties configurable using -cpu or -global. (since 2.9) 'alias-of: string' (optional) Name of CPU model this model is an alias for. The target of the CPU model alias may change depending on the machine type. Management software is supposed to translate CPU model aliases in the VM configuration, because aliases may stop being migration-safe in the future (since 4.1) 'unavailable-features' is a list of QOM property names that represent CPU model attributes that prevent the CPU from running. If the QOM property is read-only, that means there's no known way to make the CPU model run in the current host. Implementations that choose not to provide specific information return the property name "type". If the property is read-write, it means that it MAY be possible to run the CPU model in the current host if that property is changed. Management software can use it as hints to suggest or choose an alternative for the user, or just to generate meaningful error messages explaining why the CPU model can't be used. If 'unavailable-features' is an empty list, the CPU model is runnable using the current host and machine-type. If 'unavailable-features' is not present, runnability information for the CPU is not available. Since: 1.2.0 If: 'defined(TARGET_PPC) || defined(TARGET_ARM) || defined(TARGET_I386) || defined(TARGET_S390X) || defined(TARGET_MIPS)' -- Command: query-cpu-definitions Return a list of supported virtual CPU definitions Returns: a list of CpuDefInfo Since: 1.2.0 If: 'defined(TARGET_PPC) || defined(TARGET_ARM) || defined(TARGET_I386) || defined(TARGET_S390X) || defined(TARGET_MIPS)' 1.23 Miscellanea ================ -- Command: qmp_capabilities Enable QMP capabilities. Arguments: Arguments: 'enable: array of QMPCapability' (optional) An optional list of QMPCapability values to enable. The client must not enable any capability that is not mentioned in the QMP greeting message. If the field is not provided, it means no QMP capabilities will be enabled. (since 2.12) Example: -> { "execute": "qmp_capabilities", "arguments": { "enable": [ "oob" ] } } <- { "return": {} } Notes: This command is valid exactly when first connecting: it must be issued before any other command will be accepted, and will fail once the monitor is accepting other commands. (see qemu docs/interop/qmp-spec.txt) The QMP client needs to explicitly enable QMP capabilities, otherwise all the QMP capabilities will be turned off by default. Since: 0.13 -- Enum: QMPCapability Enumeration of capabilities to be advertised during initial client connection, used for agreeing on particular QMP extension behaviors. Values: 'oob' QMP ability to support out-of-band requests. (Please refer to qmp-spec.txt for more information on OOB) Since: 2.12 -- Object: VersionTriple A three-part version number. Members: 'major: int' The major version number. 'minor: int' The minor version number. 'micro: int' The micro version number. Since: 2.4 -- Object: VersionInfo A description of QEMU's version. Members: 'qemu: VersionTriple' The version of QEMU. By current convention, a micro version of 50 signifies a development branch. A micro version greater than or equal to 90 signifies a release candidate for the next minor version. A micro version of less than 50 signifies a stable release. 'package: string' QEMU will always set this field to an empty string. Downstream versions of QEMU should set this to a non-empty string. The exact format depends on the downstream however it highly recommended that a unique name is used. Since: 0.14.0 -- Command: query-version Returns the current version of QEMU. Returns: A 'VersionInfo' object describing the current version of QEMU. Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-version" } <- { "return":{ "qemu":{ "major":0, "minor":11, "micro":5 }, "package":"" } } -- Object: CommandInfo Information about a QMP command Members: 'name: string' The command name Since: 0.14.0 -- Command: query-commands Return a list of supported QMP commands by this server Returns: A list of 'CommandInfo' for all supported commands Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-commands" } <- { "return":[ { "name":"query-balloon" }, { "name":"system_powerdown" } ] } Note: This example has been shortened as the real response is too long. -- Enum: LostTickPolicy Policy for handling lost ticks in timer devices. Values: 'discard' throw away the missed tick(s) and continue with future injection normally. Guest time may be delayed, unless the OS has explicit handling of lost ticks 'delay' continue to deliver ticks at the normal rate. Guest time will be delayed due to the late tick 'slew' deliver ticks at a higher rate to catch up with the missed tick. The guest time should not be delayed once catchup is complete. Since: 2.0 -- Command: add_client Allow client connections for VNC, Spice and socket based character devices to be passed in to QEMU via SCM_RIGHTS. Arguments: 'protocol: string' protocol name. Valid names are "vnc", "spice" or the name of a character device (eg. from -chardev id=XXXX) 'fdname: string' file descriptor name previously passed via 'getfd' command 'skipauth: boolean' (optional) whether to skip authentication. Only applies to "vnc" and "spice" protocols 'tls: boolean' (optional) whether to perform TLS. Only applies to the "spice" protocol Returns: nothing on success. Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "add_client", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc", "fdname": "myclient" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Object: NameInfo Guest name information. Members: 'name: string' (optional) The name of the guest Since: 0.14.0 -- Command: query-name Return the name information of a guest. Returns: 'NameInfo' of the guest Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-name" } <- { "return": { "name": "qemu-name" } } -- Object: KvmInfo Information about support for KVM acceleration Members: 'enabled: boolean' true if KVM acceleration is active 'present: boolean' true if KVM acceleration is built into this executable Since: 0.14.0 -- Command: query-kvm Returns information about KVM acceleration Returns: 'KvmInfo' Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-kvm" } <- { "return": { "enabled": true, "present": true } } -- Object: UuidInfo Guest UUID information (Universally Unique Identifier). Members: 'UUID: string' the UUID of the guest Since: 0.14.0 Notes: If no UUID was specified for the guest, a null UUID is returned. -- Command: query-uuid Query the guest UUID information. Returns: The 'UuidInfo' for the guest Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-uuid" } <- { "return": { "UUID": "550e8400-e29b-41d4-a716-446655440000" } } -- Object: EventInfo Information about a QMP event Members: 'name: string' The event name Since: 1.2.0 -- Command: query-events Return information on QMP events. Returns: A list of 'EventInfo'. Since: 1.2.0 Note: This command is deprecated, because its output doesn't reflect compile-time configuration. Use query-qmp-schema instead. Example: -> { "execute": "query-events" } <- { "return": [ { "name":"SHUTDOWN" }, { "name":"RESET" } ] } Note: This example has been shortened as the real response is too long. -- Object: IOThreadInfo Information about an iothread Members: 'id: string' the identifier of the iothread 'thread-id: int' ID of the underlying host thread 'poll-max-ns: int' maximum polling time in ns, 0 means polling is disabled (since 2.9) 'poll-grow: int' how many ns will be added to polling time, 0 means that it's not configured (since 2.9) 'poll-shrink: int' how many ns will be removed from polling time, 0 means that it's not configured (since 2.9) Since: 2.0 -- Command: query-iothreads Returns a list of information about each iothread. Note: this list excludes the QEMU main loop thread, which is not declared using the -object iothread command-line option. It is always the main thread of the process. Returns: a list of 'IOThreadInfo' for each iothread Since: 2.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-iothreads" } <- { "return": [ { "id":"iothread0", "thread-id":3134 }, { "id":"iothread1", "thread-id":3135 } ] } -- Object: BalloonInfo Information about the guest balloon device. Members: 'actual: int' the number of bytes the balloon currently contains Since: 0.14.0 -- Command: query-balloon Return information about the balloon device. Returns: 'BalloonInfo' on success If the balloon driver is enabled but not functional because the KVM kernel module cannot support it, KvmMissingCap If no balloon device is present, DeviceNotActive Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-balloon" } <- { "return": { "actual": 1073741824, } } -- Event: BALLOON_CHANGE Emitted when the guest changes the actual BALLOON level. This value is equivalent to the 'actual' field return by the 'query-balloon' command Arguments: 'actual: int' actual level of the guest memory balloon in bytes Note: this event is rate-limited. Since: 1.2 Example: <- { "event": "BALLOON_CHANGE", "data": { "actual": 944766976 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267020223, "microseconds": 435656 } } -- Object: PciMemoryRange A PCI device memory region Members: 'base: int' the starting address (guest physical) 'limit: int' the ending address (guest physical) Since: 0.14.0 -- Object: PciMemoryRegion Information about a PCI device I/O region. Members: 'bar: int' the index of the Base Address Register for this region 'type: string' 'io' if the region is a PIO region 'memory' if the region is a MMIO region 'size: int' memory size 'prefetch: boolean' (optional) if 'type' is 'memory', true if the memory is prefetchable 'mem_type_64: boolean' (optional) if 'type' is 'memory', true if the BAR is 64-bit 'address: int' Not documented Since: 0.14.0 -- Object: PciBusInfo Information about a bus of a PCI Bridge device Members: 'number: int' primary bus interface number. This should be the number of the bus the device resides on. 'secondary: int' secondary bus interface number. This is the number of the main bus for the bridge 'subordinate: int' This is the highest number bus that resides below the bridge. 'io_range: PciMemoryRange' The PIO range for all devices on this bridge 'memory_range: PciMemoryRange' The MMIO range for all devices on this bridge 'prefetchable_range: PciMemoryRange' The range of prefetchable MMIO for all devices on this bridge Since: 2.4 -- Object: PciBridgeInfo Information about a PCI Bridge device Members: 'bus: PciBusInfo' information about the bus the device resides on 'devices: array of PciDeviceInfo' (optional) a list of 'PciDeviceInfo' for each device on this bridge Since: 0.14.0 -- Object: PciDeviceClass Information about the Class of a PCI device Members: 'desc: string' (optional) a string description of the device's class 'class: int' the class code of the device Since: 2.4 -- Object: PciDeviceId Information about the Id of a PCI device Members: 'device: int' the PCI device id 'vendor: int' the PCI vendor id 'subsystem: int' (optional) the PCI subsystem id (since 3.1) 'subsystem-vendor: int' (optional) the PCI subsystem vendor id (since 3.1) Since: 2.4 -- Object: PciDeviceInfo Information about a PCI device Members: 'bus: int' the bus number of the device 'slot: int' the slot the device is located in 'function: int' the function of the slot used by the device 'class_info: PciDeviceClass' the class of the device 'id: PciDeviceId' the PCI device id 'irq: int' (optional) if an IRQ is assigned to the device, the IRQ number 'qdev_id: string' the device name of the PCI device 'pci_bridge: PciBridgeInfo' (optional) if the device is a PCI bridge, the bridge information 'regions: array of PciMemoryRegion' a list of the PCI I/O regions associated with the device Notes: the contents of 'class_info'.desc are not stable and should only be treated as informational. Since: 0.14.0 -- Object: PciInfo Information about a PCI bus Members: 'bus: int' the bus index 'devices: array of PciDeviceInfo' a list of devices on this bus Since: 0.14.0 -- Command: query-pci Return information about the PCI bus topology of the guest. Returns: a list of 'PciInfo' for each PCI bus. Each bus is represented by a json-object, which has a key with a json-array of all PCI devices attached to it. Each device is represented by a json-object. Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "query-pci" } <- { "return": [ { "bus": 0, "devices": [ { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "slot": 0, "class_info": { "class": 1536, "desc": "Host bridge" }, "id": { "device": 32902, "vendor": 4663 }, "function": 0, "regions": [ ] }, { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "slot": 1, "class_info": { "class": 1537, "desc": "ISA bridge" }, "id": { "device": 32902, "vendor": 28672 }, "function": 0, "regions": [ ] }, { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "slot": 1, "class_info": { "class": 257, "desc": "IDE controller" }, "id": { "device": 32902, "vendor": 28688 }, "function": 1, "regions": [ { "bar": 4, "size": 16, "address": 49152, "type": "io" } ] }, { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "slot": 2, "class_info": { "class": 768, "desc": "VGA controller" }, "id": { "device": 4115, "vendor": 184 }, "function": 0, "regions": [ { "prefetch": true, "mem_type_64": false, "bar": 0, "size": 33554432, "address": 4026531840, "type": "memory" }, { "prefetch": false, "mem_type_64": false, "bar": 1, "size": 4096, "address": 4060086272, "type": "memory" }, { "prefetch": false, "mem_type_64": false, "bar": 6, "size": 65536, "address": -1, "type": "memory" } ] }, { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "irq": 11, "slot": 4, "class_info": { "class": 1280, "desc": "RAM controller" }, "id": { "device": 6900, "vendor": 4098 }, "function": 0, "regions": [ { "bar": 0, "size": 32, "address": 49280, "type": "io" } ] } ] } ] } Note: This example has been shortened as the real response is too long. -- Command: quit This command will cause the QEMU process to exit gracefully. While every attempt is made to send the QMP response before terminating, this is not guaranteed. When using this interface, a premature EOF would not be unexpected. Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "quit" } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: stop Stop all guest VCPU execution. Since: 0.14.0 Notes: This function will succeed even if the guest is already in the stopped state. In "inmigrate" state, it will ensure that the guest remains paused once migration finishes, as if the -S option was passed on the command line. Example: -> { "execute": "stop" } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: system_reset Performs a hard reset of a guest. Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "system_reset" } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: system_powerdown Requests that a guest perform a powerdown operation. Since: 0.14.0 Notes: A guest may or may not respond to this command. This command returning does not indicate that a guest has accepted the request or that it has shut down. Many guests will respond to this command by prompting the user in some way. Example: -> { "execute": "system_powerdown" } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: memsave Save a portion of guest memory to a file. Arguments: 'val: int' the virtual address of the guest to start from 'size: int' the size of memory region to save 'filename: string' the file to save the memory to as binary data 'cpu-index: int' (optional) the index of the virtual CPU to use for translating the virtual address (defaults to CPU 0) Returns: Nothing on success Since: 0.14.0 Notes: Errors were not reliably returned until 1.1 Example: -> { "execute": "memsave", "arguments": { "val": 10, "size": 100, "filename": "/tmp/virtual-mem-dump" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: pmemsave Save a portion of guest physical memory to a file. Arguments: 'val: int' the physical address of the guest to start from 'size: int' the size of memory region to save 'filename: string' the file to save the memory to as binary data Returns: Nothing on success Since: 0.14.0 Notes: Errors were not reliably returned until 1.1 Example: -> { "execute": "pmemsave", "arguments": { "val": 10, "size": 100, "filename": "/tmp/physical-mem-dump" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: cont Resume guest VCPU execution. Since: 0.14.0 Returns: If successful, nothing Notes: This command will succeed if the guest is currently running. It will also succeed if the guest is in the "inmigrate" state; in this case, the effect of the command is to make sure the guest starts once migration finishes, removing the effect of the -S command line option if it was passed. Example: -> { "execute": "cont" } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: x-exit-preconfig Exit from "preconfig" state This command makes QEMU exit the preconfig state and proceed with VM initialization using configuration data provided on the command line and via the QMP monitor during the preconfig state. The command is only available during the preconfig state (i.e. when the -preconfig command line option was in use). Since 3.0 Returns: nothing Example: -> { "execute": "x-exit-preconfig" } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: system_wakeup Wake up guest from suspend. If the guest has wake-up from suspend support enabled (wakeup-suspend-support flag from query-current-machine), wake-up guest from suspend if the guest is in SUSPENDED state. Return an error otherwise. Since: 1.1 Returns: nothing. Note: prior to 4.0, this command does nothing in case the guest isn't suspended. Example: -> { "execute": "system_wakeup" } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: inject-nmi Injects a Non-Maskable Interrupt into the default CPU (x86/s390) or all CPUs (ppc64). The command fails when the guest doesn't support injecting. Returns: If successful, nothing Since: 0.14.0 Note: prior to 2.1, this command was only supported for x86 and s390 VMs Example: -> { "execute": "inject-nmi" } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: balloon Request the balloon driver to change its balloon size. Arguments: 'value: int' the target size of the balloon in bytes Returns: Nothing on success If the balloon driver is enabled but not functional because the KVM kernel module cannot support it, KvmMissingCap If no balloon device is present, DeviceNotActive Notes: This command just issues a request to the guest. When it returns, the balloon size may not have changed. A guest can change the balloon size independent of this command. Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "balloon", "arguments": { "value": 536870912 } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: human-monitor-command Execute a command on the human monitor and return the output. Arguments: 'command-line: string' the command to execute in the human monitor 'cpu-index: int' (optional) The CPU to use for commands that require an implicit CPU Returns: the output of the command as a string Since: 0.14.0 Notes: This command only exists as a stop-gap. Its use is highly discouraged. The semantics of this command are not guaranteed: this means that command names, arguments and responses can change or be removed at ANY time. Applications that rely on long term stability guarantees should NOT use this command. Known limitations: * This command is stateless, this means that commands that depend on state information (such as getfd) might not work * Commands that prompt the user for data don't currently work Example: -> { "execute": "human-monitor-command", "arguments": { "command-line": "info kvm" } } <- { "return": "kvm support: enabled\r\n" } -- Command: change This command is multiple commands multiplexed together. Arguments: 'device: string' This is normally the name of a block device but it may also be 'vnc'. when it's 'vnc', then sub command depends on 'target' 'target: string' If 'device' is a block device, then this is the new filename. If 'device' is 'vnc', then if the value 'password' selects the vnc change password command. Otherwise, this specifies a new server URI address to listen to for VNC connections. 'arg: string' (optional) If 'device' is a block device, then this is an optional format to open the device with. If 'device' is 'vnc' and 'target' is 'password', this is the new VNC password to set. See change-vnc-password for additional notes. Returns: Nothing on success. If 'device' is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound Notes: This interface is deprecated, and it is strongly recommended that you avoid using it. For changing block devices, use blockdev-change-medium; for changing VNC parameters, use change-vnc-password. Since: 0.14.0 Example: 1. Change a removable medium -> { "execute": "change", "arguments": { "device": "ide1-cd0", "target": "/srv/images/Fedora-12-x86_64-DVD.iso" } } <- { "return": {} } 2. Change VNC password -> { "execute": "change", "arguments": { "device": "vnc", "target": "password", "arg": "foobar1" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: xen-set-global-dirty-log Enable or disable the global dirty log mode. Arguments: 'enable: boolean' true to enable, false to disable. Returns: nothing Since: 1.3 Example: -> { "execute": "xen-set-global-dirty-log", "arguments": { "enable": true } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: getfd Receive a file descriptor via SCM rights and assign it a name Arguments: 'fdname: string' file descriptor name Returns: Nothing on success Since: 0.14.0 Notes: If 'fdname' already exists, the file descriptor assigned to it will be closed and replaced by the received file descriptor. The 'closefd' command can be used to explicitly close the file descriptor when it is no longer needed. Example: -> { "execute": "getfd", "arguments": { "fdname": "fd1" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Command: closefd Close a file descriptor previously passed via SCM rights Arguments: 'fdname: string' file descriptor name Returns: Nothing on success Since: 0.14.0 Example: -> { "execute": "closefd", "arguments": { "fdname": "fd1" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Object: MemoryInfo Actual memory information in bytes. Members: 'base-memory: int' size of "base" memory specified with command line option -m. 'plugged-memory: int' (optional) size of memory that can be hot-unplugged. This field is omitted if target doesn't support memory hotplug (i.e. CONFIG_MEM_DEVICE not defined at build time). Since: 2.11.0 -- Command: query-memory-size-summary Return the amount of initially allocated and present hotpluggable (if enabled) memory in bytes. Example: -> { "execute": "query-memory-size-summary" } <- { "return": { "base-memory": 4294967296, "plugged-memory": 0 } } Since: 2.11.0 -- Object: AddfdInfo Information about a file descriptor that was added to an fd set. Members: 'fdset-id: int' The ID of the fd set that 'fd' was added to. 'fd: int' The file descriptor that was received via SCM rights and added to the fd set. Since: 1.2.0 -- Command: add-fd Add a file descriptor, that was passed via SCM rights, to an fd set. Arguments: 'fdset-id: int' (optional) The ID of the fd set to add the file descriptor to. 'opaque: string' (optional) A free-form string that can be used to describe the fd. Returns: 'AddfdInfo' on success If file descriptor was not received, FdNotSupplied If 'fdset-id' is a negative value, InvalidParameterValue Notes: The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections. If 'fdset-id' is not specified, a new fd set will be created. Since: 1.2.0 Example: -> { "execute": "add-fd", "arguments": { "fdset-id": 1 } } <- { "return": { "fdset-id": 1, "fd": 3 } } -- Command: remove-fd Remove a file descriptor from an fd set. Arguments: 'fdset-id: int' The ID of the fd set that the file descriptor belongs to. 'fd: int' (optional) The file descriptor that is to be removed. Returns: Nothing on success If 'fdset-id' or 'fd' is not found, FdNotFound Since: 1.2.0 Notes: The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections. If 'fd' is not specified, all file descriptors in 'fdset-id' will be removed. Example: -> { "execute": "remove-fd", "arguments": { "fdset-id": 1, "fd": 3 } } <- { "return": {} } -- Object: FdsetFdInfo Information about a file descriptor that belongs to an fd set. Members: 'fd: int' The file descriptor value. 'opaque: string' (optional) A free-form string that can be used to describe the fd. Since: 1.2.0 -- Object: FdsetInfo Information about an fd set. Members: 'fdset-id: int' The ID of the fd set. 'fds: array of FdsetFdInfo' A list of file descriptors that belong to this fd set. Since: 1.2.0 -- Command: query-fdsets Return information describing all fd sets. Returns: A list of 'FdsetInfo' Since: 1.2.0 Note: The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections. Example: -> { "execute": "query-fdsets" } <- { "return": [ { "fds": [ { "fd": 30, "opaque": "rdonly:/path/to/file" }, { "fd": 24, "opaque": "rdwr:/path/to/file" } ], "fdset-id": 1 }, { "fds": [ { "fd": 28 }, { "fd": 29 } ], "fdset-id": 0 } ] } -- Object: TargetInfo Information describing the QEMU target. Members: 'arch: SysEmuTarget' the target architecture Since: 1.2.0 -- Command: query-target Return information about the target for this QEMU Returns: TargetInfo Since: 1.2.0 -- Object: AcpiTableOptions Specify an ACPI table on the command line to load. At most one of 'file' and 'data' can be specified. The list of files specified by any one of them is loaded and concatenated in order. If both are omitted, 'data' is implied. Other fields / optargs can be used to override fields of the generic ACPI table header; refer to the ACPI specification 5.0, section 5.2.6 System Description Table Header. If a header field is not overridden, then the corresponding value from the concatenated blob is used (in case of 'file'), or it is filled in with a hard-coded value (in case of 'data'). String fields are copied into the matching ACPI member from lowest address upwards, and silently truncated / NUL-padded to length. Members: 'sig: string' (optional) table signature / identifier (4 bytes) 'rev: int' (optional) table revision number (dependent on signature, 1 byte) 'oem_id: string' (optional) OEM identifier (6 bytes) 'oem_table_id: string' (optional) OEM table identifier (8 bytes) 'oem_rev: int' (optional) OEM-supplied revision number (4 bytes) 'asl_compiler_id: string' (optional) identifier of the utility that created the table (4 bytes) 'asl_compiler_rev: int' (optional) revision number of the utility that created the table (4 bytes) 'file: string' (optional) colon (:) separated list of pathnames to load and concatenate as table data. The resultant binary blob is expected to have an ACPI table header. At least one file is required. This field excludes 'data'. 'data: string' (optional) colon (:) separated list of pathnames to load and concatenate as table data. The resultant binary blob must not have an ACPI table header. At least one file is required. This field excludes 'file'. Since: 1.5 -- Enum: CommandLineParameterType Possible types for an option parameter. Values: 'string' accepts a character string 'boolean' accepts "on" or "off" 'number' accepts a number 'size' accepts a number followed by an optional suffix (K)ilo, (M)ega, (G)iga, (T)era Since: 1.5 -- Object: CommandLineParameterInfo Details about a single parameter of a command line option. Members: 'name: string' parameter name 'type: CommandLineParameterType' parameter 'CommandLineParameterType' 'help: string' (optional) human readable text string, not suitable for parsing. 'default: string' (optional) default value string (since 2.1) Since: 1.5 -- Object: CommandLineOptionInfo Details about a command line option, including its list of parameter details Members: 'option: string' option name 'parameters: array of CommandLineParameterInfo' an array of 'CommandLineParameterInfo' Since: 1.5 -- Command: query-command-line-options Query command line option schema. Arguments: 'option: string' (optional) option name Returns: list of 'CommandLineOptionInfo' for all options (or for the given 'option'). Returns an error if the given 'option' doesn't exist. Since: 1.5 Example: -> { "execute": "query-command-line-options", "arguments": { "option": "option-rom" } } <- { "return": [ { "parameters": [ { "name": "romfile", "type": "string" }, { "name": "bootindex", "type": "number" } ], "option": "option-rom" } ] } -- Object: PCDIMMDeviceInfo PCDIMMDevice state information Members: 'id: string' (optional) device's ID 'addr: int' physical address, where device is mapped 'size: int' size of memory that the device provides 'slot: int' slot number at which device is plugged in 'node: int' NUMA node number where device is plugged in 'memdev: string' memory backend linked with device 'hotplugged: boolean' true if device was hotplugged 'hotpluggable: boolean' true if device if could be added/removed while machine is running Since: 2.1 -- Object: VirtioPMEMDeviceInfo VirtioPMEM state information Members: 'id: string' (optional) device's ID 'memaddr: int' physical address in memory, where device is mapped 'size: int' size of memory that the device provides 'memdev: string' memory backend linked with device Since: 4.1 -- Object: MemoryDeviceInfo Union containing information about a memory device nvdimm is included since 2.12. virtio-pmem is included since 4.1. Members: 'type' One of "dimm", "nvdimm", "virtio-pmem" 'data: PCDIMMDeviceInfo' when 'type' is "dimm" 'data: PCDIMMDeviceInfo' when 'type' is "nvdimm" 'data: VirtioPMEMDeviceInfo' when 'type' is "virtio-pmem" Since: 2.1 -- Command: query-memory-devices Lists available memory devices and their state Since: 2.1 Example: -> { "execute": "query-memory-devices" } <- { "return": [ { "data": { "addr": 5368709120, "hotpluggable": true, "hotplugged": true, "id": "d1", "memdev": "/objects/memX", "node": 0, "size": 1073741824, "slot": 0}, "type": "dimm" } ] } -- Event: MEM_UNPLUG_ERROR Emitted when memory hot unplug error occurs. Arguments: 'device: string' device name 'msg: string' Informative message Since: 2.4 Example: <- { "event": "MEM_UNPLUG_ERROR" "data": { "device": "dimm1", "msg": "acpi: device unplug for unsupported device" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } -- Enum: ACPISlotType Values: 'DIMM' memory slot 'CPU' logical CPU slot (since 2.7) -- Object: ACPIOSTInfo OSPM Status Indication for a device For description of possible values of 'source' and 'status' fields see "_OST (OSPM Status Indication)" chapter of ACPI5.0 spec. Members: 'device: string' (optional) device ID associated with slot 'slot: string' slot ID, unique per slot of a given 'slot-type' 'slot-type: ACPISlotType' type of the slot 'source: int' an integer containing the source event 'status: int' an integer containing the status code Since: 2.1 -- Command: query-acpi-ospm-status Return a list of ACPIOSTInfo for devices that support status reporting via ACPI _OST method. Since: 2.1 Example: -> { "execute": "query-acpi-ospm-status" } <- { "return": [ { "device": "d1", "slot": "0", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 1, "status": 0}, { "slot": "1", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0}, { "slot": "2", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0}, { "slot": "3", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0} ]} -- Event: ACPI_DEVICE_OST Emitted when guest executes ACPI _OST method. Arguments: 'info: ACPIOSTInfo' OSPM Status Indication Since: 2.1 Example: <- { "event": "ACPI_DEVICE_OST", "data": { "device": "d1", "slot": "0", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 1, "status": 0 } } -- Enum: ReplayMode Mode of the replay subsystem. Values: 'none' normal execution mode. Replay or record are not enabled. 'record' record mode. All non-deterministic data is written into the replay log. 'play' replay mode. Non-deterministic data required for system execution is read from the log. Since: 2.5 -- Command: xen-load-devices-state Load the state of all devices from file. The RAM and the block devices of the VM are not loaded by this command. Arguments: 'filename: string' the file to load the state of the devices from as binary data. See xen-save-devices-state.txt for a description of the binary format. Since: 2.7 Example: -> { "execute": "xen-load-devices-state", "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/resume" } } <- { "return": {} } -- Object: GuidInfo GUID information. Members: 'guid: string' the globally unique identifier Since: 2.9 -- Command: query-vm-generation-id Show Virtual Machine Generation ID Since: 2.9 -- Event: RTC_CHANGE Emitted when the guest changes the RTC time. Arguments: 'offset: int' offset between base RTC clock (as specified by -rtc base), and new RTC clock value Note: This event is rate-limited. Since: 0.13.0 Example: <- { "event": "RTC_CHANGE", "data": { "offset": 78 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267020223, "microseconds": 435656 } } If: 'defined(TARGET_ALPHA) || defined(TARGET_ARM) || defined(TARGET_HPPA) || defined(TARGET_I386) || defined(TARGET_MIPS) || defined(TARGET_MIPS64) || defined(TARGET_MOXIE) || defined(TARGET_PPC) || defined(TARGET_PPC64) || defined(TARGET_S390X) || defined(TARGET_SH4) || defined(TARGET_SPARC)' -- Command: rtc-reset-reinjection This command will reset the RTC interrupt reinjection backlog. Can be used if another mechanism to synchronize guest time is in effect, for example QEMU guest agent's guest-set-time command. Since: 2.1 Example: -> { "execute": "rtc-reset-reinjection" } <- { "return": {} } If: 'defined(TARGET_I386)' -- Enum: SevState An enumeration of SEV state information used during 'query-sev'. Values: 'uninit' The guest is uninitialized. 'launch-update' The guest is currently being launched; plaintext data and register state is being imported. 'launch-secret' The guest is currently being launched; ciphertext data is being imported. 'running' The guest is fully launched or migrated in. 'send-update' The guest is currently being migrated out to another machine. 'receive-update' The guest is currently being migrated from another machine. Since: 2.12 If: 'defined(TARGET_I386)' -- Object: SevInfo Information about Secure Encrypted Virtualization (SEV) support Members: 'enabled: boolean' true if SEV is active 'api-major: int' SEV API major version 'api-minor: int' SEV API minor version 'build-id: int' SEV FW build id 'policy: int' SEV policy value 'state: SevState' SEV guest state 'handle: int' SEV firmware handle Since: 2.12 If: 'defined(TARGET_I386)' -- Command: query-sev Returns information about SEV Returns: 'SevInfo' Since: 2.12 Example: -> { "execute": "query-sev" } <- { "return": { "enabled": true, "api-major" : 0, "api-minor" : 0, "build-id" : 0, "policy" : 0, "state" : "running", "handle" : 1 } } If: 'defined(TARGET_I386)' -- Object: SevLaunchMeasureInfo SEV Guest Launch measurement information Members: 'data: string' the measurement value encoded in base64 Since: 2.12 If: 'defined(TARGET_I386)' -- Command: query-sev-launch-measure Query the SEV guest launch information. Returns: The 'SevLaunchMeasureInfo' for the guest Since: 2.12 Example: -> { "execute": "query-sev-launch-measure" } <- { "return": { "data": "4l8LXeNlSPUDlXPJG5966/8%YZ" } } If: 'defined(TARGET_I386)' -- Object: SevCapability The struct describes capability for a Secure Encrypted Virtualization feature. Members: 'pdh: string' Platform Diffie-Hellman key (base64 encoded) 'cert-chain: string' PDH certificate chain (base64 encoded) 'cbitpos: int' C-bit location in page table entry 'reduced-phys-bits: int' Number of physical Address bit reduction when SEV is enabled Since: 2.12 If: 'defined(TARGET_I386)' -- Command: query-sev-capabilities This command is used to get the SEV capabilities, and is supported on AMD X86 platforms only. Returns: SevCapability objects. Since: 2.12 Example: -> { "execute": "query-sev-capabilities" } <- { "return": { "pdh": "8CCDD8DDD", "cert-chain": "888CCCDDDEE", "cbitpos": 47, "reduced-phys-bits": 5}} If: 'defined(TARGET_I386)' -- Command: dump-skeys Dump guest's storage keys Arguments: 'filename: string' the path to the file to dump to This command is only supported on s390 architecture. Since: 2.5 Example: -> { "execute": "dump-skeys", "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/skeys" } } <- { "return": {} } If: 'defined(TARGET_S390X)' -- Object: GICCapability The struct describes capability for a specific GIC (Generic Interrupt Controller) version. These bits are not only decided by QEMU/KVM software version, but also decided by the hardware that the program is running upon. Members: 'version: int' version of GIC to be described. Currently, only 2 and 3 are supported. 'emulated: boolean' whether current QEMU/hardware supports emulated GIC device in user space. 'kernel: boolean' whether current QEMU/hardware supports hardware accelerated GIC device in kernel. Since: 2.6 If: 'defined(TARGET_ARM)' -- Command: query-gic-capabilities This command is ARM-only. It will return a list of GICCapability objects that describe its capability bits. Returns: a list of GICCapability objects. Since: 2.6 Example: -> { "execute": "query-gic-capabilities" } <- { "return": [{ "version": 2, "emulated": true, "kernel": false }, { "version": 3, "emulated": false, "kernel": true } ] } If: 'defined(TARGET_ARM)' -- Object: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions General audio backend options that are used for both playback and recording. Members: 'fixed-settings: boolean' (optional) use fixed settings for host input/output. When off, frequency, channels and format must not be specified (default true) 'frequency: int' (optional) frequency to use when using fixed settings (default 44100) 'channels: int' (optional) number of channels when using fixed settings (default 2) 'voices: int' (optional) number of voices to use (default 1) 'format: AudioFormat' (optional) sample format to use when using fixed settings (default s16) 'buffer-length: int' (optional) the buffer length in microseconds Since: 4.0 -- Object: AudiodevGenericOptions Generic driver-specific options. Members: 'in: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the capture stream 'out: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the playback stream Since: 4.0 -- Object: AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions Options of the ALSA backend that are used for both playback and recording. Members: 'dev: string' (optional) the name of the ALSA device to use (default 'default') 'period-length: int' (optional) the period length in microseconds 'try-poll: boolean' (optional) attempt to use poll mode, falling back to non-polling access on failure (default true) The members of 'AudiodevPerDirectionOptions' Since: 4.0 -- Object: AudiodevAlsaOptions Options of the ALSA audio backend. Members: 'in: AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the capture stream 'out: AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the playback stream 'threshold: int' (optional) set the threshold (in microseconds) when playback starts Since: 4.0 -- Object: AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions Options of the Core Audio backend that are used for both playback and recording. Members: 'buffer-count: int' (optional) number of buffers The members of 'AudiodevPerDirectionOptions' Since: 4.0 -- Object: AudiodevCoreaudioOptions Options of the coreaudio audio backend. Members: 'in: AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the capture stream 'out: AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the playback stream Since: 4.0 -- Object: AudiodevDsoundOptions Options of the DirectSound audio backend. Members: 'in: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the capture stream 'out: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the playback stream 'latency: int' (optional) add extra latency to playback in microseconds (default 10000) Since: 4.0 -- Object: AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions Options of the OSS backend that are used for both playback and recording. Members: 'dev: string' (optional) file name of the OSS device (default '/dev/dsp') 'buffer-count: int' (optional) number of buffers 'try-poll: boolean' (optional) attempt to use poll mode, falling back to non-polling access on failure (default true) The members of 'AudiodevPerDirectionOptions' Since: 4.0 -- Object: AudiodevOssOptions Options of the OSS audio backend. Members: 'in: AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the capture stream 'out: AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the playback stream 'try-mmap: boolean' (optional) try using memory-mapped access, falling back to non-memory-mapped access on failure (default true) 'exclusive: boolean' (optional) open device in exclusive mode (vmix won't work) (default false) 'dsp-policy: int' (optional) set the timing policy of the device (between 0 and 10, where smaller number means smaller latency but higher CPU usage) or -1 to use fragment mode (option ignored on some platforms) (default 5) Since: 4.0 -- Object: AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions Options of the Pulseaudio backend that are used for both playback and recording. Members: 'name: string' (optional) name of the sink/source to use 'latency: int' (optional) latency you want PulseAudio to achieve in microseconds (default 15000) The members of 'AudiodevPerDirectionOptions' Since: 4.0 -- Object: AudiodevPaOptions Options of the PulseAudio audio backend. Members: 'in: AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the capture stream 'out: AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the playback stream 'server: string' (optional) PulseAudio server address (default: let PulseAudio choose) Since: 4.0 -- Object: AudiodevWavOptions Options of the wav audio backend. Members: 'in: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the capture stream 'out: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions' (optional) options of the playback stream 'path: string' (optional) name of the wav file to record (default 'qemu.wav') Since: 4.0 -- Enum: AudioFormat An enumeration of possible audio formats. Values: 'u8' Not documented 's8' Not documented 'u16' Not documented 's16' Not documented 'u32' Not documented 's32' Not documented Since: 4.0 -- Enum: AudiodevDriver An enumeration of possible audio backend drivers. Values: 'none' Not documented 'alsa' Not documented 'coreaudio' Not documented 'dsound' Not documented 'oss' Not documented 'pa' Not documented 'sdl' Not documented 'spice' Not documented 'wav' Not documented Since: 4.0 -- Object: Audiodev Options of an audio backend. Members: 'id: string' identifier of the backend 'driver: AudiodevDriver' the backend driver to use 'timer-period: int' (optional) timer period (in microseconds, 0: use lowest possible) The members of 'AudiodevGenericOptions' when 'driver' is "none" The members of 'AudiodevAlsaOptions' when 'driver' is "alsa" The members of 'AudiodevCoreaudioOptions' when 'driver' is "coreaudio" The members of 'AudiodevDsoundOptions' when 'driver' is "dsound" The members of 'AudiodevOssOptions' when 'driver' is "oss" The members of 'AudiodevPaOptions' when 'driver' is "pa" The members of 'AudiodevGenericOptions' when 'driver' is "sdl" The members of 'AudiodevGenericOptions' when 'driver' is "spice" The members of 'AudiodevWavOptions' when 'driver' is "wav" Since: 4.0 Commands and Events Index ************************* * Menu: * ACPI_DEVICE_OST: API Reference. (line 14096) * add-fd: API Reference. (line 13698) * add_client: API Reference. (line 12822) * announce-self: API Reference. (line 7858) * balloon: API Reference. (line 13507) * BALLOON_CHANGE: API Reference. (line 13033) * block-commit: API Reference. (line 2678) * block-dirty-bitmap-add: API Reference. (line 3120) * block-dirty-bitmap-clear: API Reference. (line 3153) * block-dirty-bitmap-disable: API Reference. (line 3185) * block-dirty-bitmap-enable: API Reference. (line 3170) * block-dirty-bitmap-merge: API Reference. (line 3200) * block-dirty-bitmap-remove: API Reference. (line 3136) * block-job-cancel: API Reference. (line 3611) * block-job-complete: API Reference. (line 3696) * block-job-dismiss: API Reference. (line 3724) * block-job-finalize: API Reference. (line 3744) * block-job-pause: API Reference. (line 3651) * block-job-resume: API Reference. (line 3675) * block-job-set-speed: API Reference. (line 3589) * block-latency-histogram-set: API Reference. (line 1813) * block-set-write-threshold: API Reference. (line 6096) * block-stream: API Reference. (line 3507) * blockdev-add: API Reference. (line 4996) * blockdev-backup: API Reference. (line 2787) * blockdev-change-medium: API Reference. (line 5781) * blockdev-close-tray: API Reference. (line 5668) * blockdev-create: API Reference. (line 5612) * blockdev-del: API Reference. (line 5085) * blockdev-insert-medium: API Reference. (line 5736) * blockdev-mirror: API Reference. (line 3245) * blockdev-open-tray: API Reference. (line 5625) * blockdev-remove-medium: API Reference. (line 5697) * blockdev-snapshot: API Reference. (line 2622) * blockdev-snapshot-delete-internal-sync: API Reference. (line 6330) * blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync: API Reference. (line 6301) * blockdev-snapshot-sync: API Reference. (line 2603) * BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED: API Reference. (line 5847) * BLOCK_IO_ERROR: API Reference. (line 5888) * BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED: API Reference. (line 5961) * BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED: API Reference. (line 5929) * BLOCK_JOB_ERROR: API Reference. (line 5988) * BLOCK_JOB_PENDING: API Reference. (line 6039) * BLOCK_JOB_READY: API Reference. (line 6010) * block_passwd: API Reference. (line 2402) * block_resize: API Reference. (line 2418) * block_set_io_throttle: API Reference. (line 3316) * BLOCK_WRITE_THRESHOLD: API Reference. (line 6078) * change: API Reference. (line 13561) * change-backing-file: API Reference. (line 2650) * change-vnc-password: API Reference. (line 8868) * chardev-add: API Reference. (line 6982) * chardev-change: API Reference. (line 7013) * chardev-remove: API Reference. (line 7049) * chardev-send-break: API Reference. (line 7065) * client_migrate_info: API Reference. (line 10417) * closefd: API Reference. (line 13644) * COLO_EXIT: API Reference. (line 10542) * cont: API Reference. (line 13436) * cpu-add: API Reference. (line 11973) * device-list-properties: API Reference. (line 11610) * device_add: API Reference. (line 11627) * device_del: API Reference. (line 11662) * DEVICE_DELETED: API Reference. (line 11691) * DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED: API Reference. (line 6488) * drive-backup: API Reference. (line 2765) * drive-mirror: API Reference. (line 2961) * dump-guest-memory: API Reference. (line 7120) * dump-skeys: API Reference. (line 14325) * DUMP_COMPLETED: API Reference. (line 7222) * eject: API Reference. (line 6371) * expire_password: API Reference. (line 8352) * getfd: API Reference. (line 13622) * GUEST_PANICKED: API Reference. (line 734) * human-monitor-command: API Reference. (line 13529) * inject-nmi: API Reference. (line 13490) * input-send-event: API Reference. (line 9440) * job-cancel: API Reference. (line 1258) * job-complete: API Reference. (line 1277) * job-dismiss: API Reference. (line 1287) * job-finalize: API Reference. (line 1304) * job-pause: API Reference. (line 1224) * job-resume: API Reference. (line 1243) * JOB_STATUS_CHANGE: API Reference. (line 1212) * memsave: API Reference. (line 13383) * MEM_UNPLUG_ERROR: API Reference. (line 14034) * migrate: API Reference. (line 10698) * migrate-continue: API Reference. (line 10606) * migrate-incoming: API Reference. (line 10733) * migrate-pause: API Reference. (line 10899) * migrate-recover: API Reference. (line 10882) * migrate-set-cache-size: API Reference. (line 10661) * migrate-set-capabilities: API Reference. (line 10078) * migrate-set-parameters: API Reference. (line 10297) * migrate-start-postcopy: API Reference. (line 10445) * migrate_cancel: API Reference. (line 10591) * migrate_set_downtime: API Reference. (line 10623) * migrate_set_speed: API Reference. (line 10642) * MIGRATION: API Reference. (line 10457) * MIGRATION_PASS: API Reference. (line 10472) * nbd-server-add: API Reference. (line 6420) * nbd-server-remove: API Reference. (line 6463) * nbd-server-start: API Reference. (line 6396) * nbd-server-stop: API Reference. (line 6481) * netdev_add: API Reference. (line 7292) * netdev_del: API Reference. (line 7320) * NIC_RX_FILTER_CHANGED: API Reference. (line 7814) * object-add: API Reference. (line 11567) * object-del: API Reference. (line 11590) * pmemsave: API Reference. (line 13411) * POWERDOWN: API Reference. (line 591) * PR_MANAGER_STATUS_CHANGED: API Reference. (line 6514) * qmp_capabilities: API Reference. (line 12673) * qom-get: API Reference. (line 11450) * qom-list: API Reference. (line 11427) * qom-list-properties: API Reference. (line 11551) * qom-list-types: API Reference. (line 11536) * qom-set: API Reference. (line 11499) * query-acpi-ospm-status: API Reference. (line 14081) * query-balloon: API Reference. (line 13013) * query-block: API Reference. (line 1941) * query-block-jobs: API Reference. (line 2394) * query-blockstats: API Reference. (line 2176) * query-chardev: API Reference. (line 6630) * query-chardev-backends: API Reference. (line 6670) * query-colo-status: API Reference. (line 10870) * query-command-line-options: API Reference. (line 13924) * query-commands: API Reference. (line 12779) * query-cpu-definitions: API Reference. (line 12658) * query-cpu-model-baseline: API Reference. (line 12498) * query-cpu-model-comparison: API Reference. (line 12446) * query-cpu-model-expansion: API Reference. (line 12560) * query-cpus: API Reference. (line 11867) * query-cpus-fast: API Reference. (line 11933) * query-current-machine: API Reference. (line 12037) * query-display-options: API Reference. (line 9637) * query-dump: API Reference. (line 7209) * query-dump-guest-memory-capability: API Reference. (line 7251) * query-events: API Reference. (line 12929) * query-fdsets: API Reference. (line 13773) * query-gic-capabilities: API Reference. (line 14365) * query-hotpluggable-cpus: API Reference. (line 12282) * query-iothreads: API Reference. (line 12977) * query-jobs: API Reference. (line 1353) * query-kvm: API Reference. (line 12882) * query-machines: API Reference. (line 12019) * query-memdev: API Reference. (line 12209) * query-memory-devices: API Reference. (line 14014) * query-memory-size-summary: API Reference. (line 13674) * query-mice: API Reference. (line 8976) * query-migrate: API Reference. (line 9873) * query-migrate-cache-size: API Reference. (line 10683) * query-migrate-capabilities: API Reference. (line 10092) * query-migrate-parameters: API Reference. (line 10396) * query-name: API Reference. (line 12858) * query-named-block-nodes: API Reference. (line 2809) * query-pci: API Reference. (line 13188) * query-pr-managers: API Reference. (line 6291) * query-qmp-schema: API Reference. (line 11152) * query-rocker: API Reference. (line 7921) * query-rocker-of-dpa-flows: API Reference. (line 8100) * query-rocker-of-dpa-groups: API Reference. (line 8164) * query-rocker-ports: API Reference. (line 7981) * query-rx-filter: API Reference. (line 7771) * query-sev: API Reference. (line 14248) * query-sev-capabilities: API Reference. (line 14309) * query-sev-launch-measure: API Reference. (line 14276) * query-spice: API Reference. (line 8514) * query-status: API Reference. (line 552) * query-target: API Reference. (line 13823) * query-tpm: API Reference. (line 8299) * query-tpm-models: API Reference. (line 8211) * query-tpm-types: API Reference. (line 8235) * query-uuid: API Reference. (line 12907) * query-version: API Reference. (line 12747) * query-vm-generation-id: API Reference. (line 14155) * query-vnc: API Reference. (line 8830) * query-vnc-servers: API Reference. (line 8858) * query-xen-replication-status: API Reference. (line 10824) * quit: API Reference. (line 13330) * QUORUM_FAILURE: API Reference. (line 6548) * QUORUM_REPORT_BAD: API Reference. (line 6570) * RDMA_GID_STATUS_CHANGED: API Reference. (line 7878) * remove-fd: API Reference. (line 13725) * RESET: API Reference. (line 602) * RESUME: API Reference. (line 631) * ringbuf-read: API Reference. (line 6737) * ringbuf-write: API Reference. (line 6709) * rtc-reset-reinjection: API Reference. (line 14186) * RTC_CHANGE: API Reference. (line 14161) * screendump: API Reference. (line 8380) * send-key: API Reference. (line 9325) * set-numa-node: API Reference. (line 12332) * set_link: API Reference. (line 7268) * set_password: API Reference. (line 8327) * SHUTDOWN: API Reference. (line 566) * SPICE_CONNECTED: API Reference. (line 8556) * SPICE_DISCONNECTED: API Reference. (line 8603) * SPICE_INITIALIZED: API Reference. (line 8578) * SPICE_MIGRATE_COMPLETED: API Reference. (line 8625) * STOP: API Reference. (line 621) * stop: API Reference. (line 13343) * SUSPEND: API Reference. (line 641) * SUSPEND_DISK: API Reference. (line 652) * system_powerdown: API Reference. (line 13368) * system_reset: API Reference. (line 13358) * system_wakeup: API Reference. (line 13472) * trace-event-get-state: API Reference. (line 11092) * trace-event-set-state: API Reference. (line 11120) * transaction: API Reference. (line 10989) * VNC_CONNECTED: API Reference. (line 8884) * VNC_DISCONNECTED: API Reference. (line 8934) * VNC_INITIALIZED: API Reference. (line 8910) * VSERPORT_CHANGE: API Reference. (line 7081) * WAKEUP: API Reference. (line 667) * WATCHDOG: API Reference. (line 678) * watchdog-set-action: API Reference. (line 724) * x-blockdev-change: API Reference. (line 6122) * x-blockdev-reopen: API Reference. (line 5045) * x-blockdev-set-iothread: API Reference. (line 6176) * x-colo-lost-heartbeat: API Reference. (line 10577) * x-debug-block-dirty-bitmap-sha256: API Reference. (line 3235) * x-debug-query-block-graph: API Reference. (line 2955) * x-exit-preconfig: API Reference. (line 13454) * xen-colo-do-checkpoint: API Reference. (line 10838) * xen-load-devices-state: API Reference. (line 14127) * xen-save-devices-state: API Reference. (line 10762) * xen-set-global-dirty-log: API Reference. (line 13605) * xen-set-replication: API Reference. (line 10785) Data Types Index **************** * Menu: * Abort: API Reference. (line 10914) * ACPIOSTInfo: API Reference. (line 14061) * ACPISlotType: API Reference. (line 14053) * AcpiTableOptions: API Reference. (line 13831) * ActionCompletionMode: API Reference. (line 10920) * AddfdInfo: API Reference. (line 13685) * AnnounceParameters: API Reference. (line 7834) * Audiodev: API Reference. (line 14614) * AudiodevAlsaOptions: API Reference. (line 14433) * AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions: API Reference. (line 14416) * AudiodevCoreaudioOptions: API Reference. (line 14459) * AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions: API Reference. (line 14447) * AudiodevDriver: API Reference. (line 14588) * AudiodevDsoundOptions: API Reference. (line 14471) * AudiodevGenericOptions: API Reference. (line 14404) * AudiodevOssOptions: API Reference. (line 14502) * AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions: API Reference. (line 14485) * AudiodevPaOptions: API Reference. (line 14540) * AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions: API Reference. (line 14525) * AudiodevPerDirectionOptions: API Reference. (line 14381) * AudiodevWavOptions: API Reference. (line 14554) * AudioFormat: API Reference. (line 14568) * BalloonInfo: API Reference. (line 13003) * BiosAtaTranslation: API Reference. (line 6213) * BlkdebugEvent: API Reference. (line 4261) * BlkdebugInjectErrorOptions: API Reference. (line 4385) * BlkdebugIOType: API Reference. (line 4365) * BlkdebugSetStateOptions: API Reference. (line 4412) * BlockdevAioOptions: API Reference. (line 3791) * BlockdevBackup: API Reference. (line 2551) * BlockdevCacheInfo: API Reference. (line 1548) * BlockdevCacheOptions: API Reference. (line 3803) * BlockdevChangeReadOnlyMode: API Reference. (line 5766) * BlockdevCreateOptions: API Reference. (line 5585) * BlockdevCreateOptionsFile: API Reference. (line 5115) * BlockdevCreateOptionsGluster: API Reference. (line 5137) * BlockdevCreateOptionsLUKS: API Reference. (line 5157) * BlockdevCreateOptionsNfs: API Reference. (line 5173) * BlockdevCreateOptionsParallels: API Reference. (line 5188) * BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow: API Reference. (line 5206) * BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow2: API Reference. (line 5239) * BlockdevCreateOptionsQed: API Reference. (line 5287) * BlockdevCreateOptionsRbd: API Reference. (line 5313) * BlockdevCreateOptionsSheepdog: API Reference. (line 5454) * BlockdevCreateOptionsSsh: API Reference. (line 5480) * BlockdevCreateOptionsVdi: API Reference. (line 5495) * BlockdevCreateOptionsVhdx: API Reference. (line 5523) * BlockdevCreateOptionsVmdk: API Reference. (line 5368) * BlockdevCreateOptionsVpc: API Reference. (line 5563) * BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions: API Reference. (line 3773) * BlockdevDiscardOptions: API Reference. (line 3761) * BlockdevDriver: API Reference. (line 3816) * BlockDeviceInfo: API Reference. (line 1562) * BlockDeviceIoStatus: API Reference. (line 1651) * BlockDeviceMapEntry: API Reference. (line 1665) * BlockDeviceStats: API Reference. (line 2077) * BlockDeviceTimedStats: API Reference. (line 2034) * BlockdevOnError: API Reference. (line 2295) * BlockdevOptions: API Reference. (line 4889) * BlockdevOptionsBlkdebug: API Reference. (line 4428) * BlockdevOptionsBlklogwrites: API Reference. (line 4472) * BlockdevOptionsBlkverify: API Reference. (line 4492) * BlockdevOptionsCurlBase: API Reference. (line 4745) * BlockdevOptionsCurlFtp: API Reference. (line 4808) * BlockdevOptionsCurlFtps: API Reference. (line 4818) * BlockdevOptionsCurlHttp: API Reference. (line 4771) * BlockdevOptionsCurlHttps: API Reference. (line 4788) * BlockdevOptionsFile: API Reference. (line 3903) * BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat: API Reference. (line 4017) * BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat: API Reference. (line 3993) * BlockdevOptionsGluster: API Reference. (line 4535) * BlockdevOptionsIscsi: API Reference. (line 4581) * BlockdevOptionsLUKS: API Reference. (line 4004) * BlockdevOptionsNbd: API Reference. (line 4831) * BlockdevOptionsNfs: API Reference. (line 4718) * BlockdevOptionsNull: API Reference. (line 3942) * BlockdevOptionsNVMe: API Reference. (line 3959) * BlockdevOptionsQcow: API Reference. (line 4112) * BlockdevOptionsQcow2: API Reference. (line 4144) * BlockdevOptionsQuorum: API Reference. (line 4516) * BlockdevOptionsRaw: API Reference. (line 4849) * BlockdevOptionsRbd: API Reference. (line 4621) * BlockdevOptionsReplication: API Reference. (line 4679) * BlockdevOptionsSheepdog: API Reference. (line 4648) * BlockdevOptionsSsh: API Reference. (line 4246) * BlockdevOptionsThrottle: API Reference. (line 4876) * BlockdevOptionsVVFAT: API Reference. (line 3971) * BlockdevOptionsVxHS: API Reference. (line 4862) * BlockdevQcow2Encryption: API Reference. (line 4134) * BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat: API Reference. (line 4124) * BlockdevQcow2Version: API Reference. (line 5227) * BlockdevQcowEncryption: API Reference. (line 4103) * BlockdevQcowEncryptionFormat: API Reference. (line 4095) * BlockdevRef: API Reference. (line 4968) * BlockdevRefOrNull: API Reference. (line 4980) * BlockdevSnapshot: API Reference. (line 2478) * BlockdevSnapshotInternal: API Reference. (line 6263) * BlockdevSnapshotSync: API Reference. (line 2457) * BlockdevVhdxSubformat: API Reference. (line 5513) * BlockdevVmdkAdapterType: API Reference. (line 5352) * BlockdevVmdkSubformat: API Reference. (line 5331) * BlockdevVpcSubformat: API Reference. (line 5553) * BlockDirtyBitmap: API Reference. (line 3059) * BlockDirtyBitmapAdd: API Reference. (line 3069) * BlockDirtyBitmapMerge: API Reference. (line 3106) * BlockDirtyBitmapMergeSource: API Reference. (line 3095) * BlockDirtyBitmapSha256: API Reference. (line 3225) * BlockDirtyInfo: API Reference. (line 1731) * BlockErrorAction: API Reference. (line 5833) * BlockInfo: API Reference. (line 1882) * BlockIOThrottle: API Reference. (line 3385) * BlockJobInfo: API Reference. (line 2350) * BlockLatencyHistogramInfo: API Reference. (line 1793) * BlockMeasureInfo: API Reference. (line 1916) * BlockPermission: API Reference. (line 2893) * BlockStats: API Reference. (line 2150) * ChardevBackend: API Reference. (line 6938) * ChardevBackendInfo: API Reference. (line 6660) * ChardevCommon: API Reference. (line 6768) * ChardevFile: API Reference. (line 6781) * ChardevHostdev: API Reference. (line 6797) * ChardevInfo: API Reference. (line 6611) * ChardevMux: API Reference. (line 6861) * ChardevReturn: API Reference. (line 6971) * ChardevRingbuf: API Reference. (line 6927) * ChardevSocket: API Reference. (line 6809) * ChardevSpiceChannel: API Reference. (line 6884) * ChardevSpicePort: API Reference. (line 6897) * ChardevStdio: API Reference. (line 6872) * ChardevUdp: API Reference. (line 6848) * ChardevVC: API Reference. (line 6910) * COLOExitReason: API Reference. (line 10559) * COLOMessage: API Reference. (line 10487) * COLOMode: API Reference. (line 10509) * COLOStatus: API Reference. (line 10853) * CommandInfo: API Reference. (line 12769) * CommandLineOptionInfo: API Reference. (line 13911) * CommandLineParameterInfo: API Reference. (line 13895) * CommandLineParameterType: API Reference. (line 13878) * CompressionStats: API Reference. (line 9755) * CpuDefinitionInfo: API Reference. (line 12605) * CpuInfo: API Reference. (line 11740) * CpuInfoArch: API Reference. (line 11715) * CpuInfoFast: API Reference. (line 11909) * CpuInfoMIPS: API Reference. (line 11809) * CpuInfoPPC: API Reference. (line 11799) * CpuInfoRISCV: API Reference. (line 11829) * CpuInfoS390: API Reference. (line 11857) * CpuInfoSPARC: API Reference. (line 11787) * CpuInfoTricore: API Reference. (line 11819) * CpuInfoX86: API Reference. (line 11777) * CpuInstanceProperties: API Reference. (line 12240) * CpuModelBaselineInfo: API Reference. (line 12413) * CpuModelCompareInfo: API Reference. (line 12425) * CpuModelCompareResult: API Reference. (line 12390) * CpuModelExpansionInfo: API Reference. (line 12548) * CpuModelExpansionType: API Reference. (line 12359) * CpuModelInfo: API Reference. (line 12341) * CpuS390State: API Reference. (line 11838) * CurrentMachineParams: API Reference. (line 12027) * DataFormat: API Reference. (line 6697) * DirtyBitmapStatus: API Reference. (line 1694) * DisplayCurses: API Reference. (line 9572) * DisplayEGLHeadless: API Reference. (line 9543) * DisplayGLMode: API Reference. (line 9554) * DisplayGTK: API Reference. (line 9526) * DisplayOptions: API Reference. (line 9618) * DisplayType: API Reference. (line 9582) * DriveBackup: API Reference. (line 2491) * DriveMirror: API Reference. (line 2985) * DummyForceArrays: API Reference. (line 12146) * DumpGuestMemoryCapability: API Reference. (line 7241) * DumpGuestMemoryFormat: API Reference. (line 7101) * DumpQueryResult: API Reference. (line 7195) * DumpStatus: API Reference. (line 7179) * EventInfo: API Reference. (line 12919) * FailoverStatus: API Reference. (line 10523) * FdsetFdInfo: API Reference. (line 13749) * FdsetInfo: API Reference. (line 13761) * FloppyDriveType: API Reference. (line 6245) * GICCapability: API Reference. (line 14343) * GrabToggleKeys: API Reference. (line 9508) * GuestPanicAction: API Reference. (line 750) * GuestPanicInformation: API Reference. (line 774) * GuestPanicInformationHyperV: API Reference. (line 786) * GuestPanicInformationS390: API Reference. (line 824) * GuestPanicInformationType: API Reference. (line 762) * GuidInfo: API Reference. (line 14145) * HostMemPolicy: API Reference. (line 12169) * HotpluggableCPU: API Reference. (line 12267) * ImageCheck: API Reference. (line 1489) * ImageInfo: API Reference. (line 1452) * ImageInfoSpecific: API Reference. (line 1438) * ImageInfoSpecificQCow2: API Reference. (line 1397) * ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Encryption: API Reference. (line 1389) * ImageInfoSpecificQCow2EncryptionBase: API Reference. (line 1381) * ImageInfoSpecificVmdk: API Reference. (line 1424) * InetSocketAddress: API Reference. (line 348) * InetSocketAddressBase: API Reference. (line 340) * InputAxis: API Reference. (line 9372) * InputBtnEvent: API Reference. (line 9396) * InputButton: API Reference. (line 9350) * InputEvent: API Reference. (line 9421) * InputKeyEvent: API Reference. (line 9384) * InputMoveEvent: API Reference. (line 9408) * IoOperationType: API Reference. (line 113) * IOThreadInfo: API Reference. (line 12956) * IscsiHeaderDigest: API Reference. (line 4565) * IscsiTransport: API Reference. (line 4553) * JobInfo: API Reference. (line 1322) * JobStatus: API Reference. (line 1143) * JobType: API Reference. (line 1125) * JobVerb: API Reference. (line 1190) * JSONType: API Reference. (line 11243) * KeyValue: API Reference. (line 9313) * KvmInfo: API Reference. (line 12870) * LostTickPolicy: API Reference. (line 12803) * MachineInfo: API Reference. (line 11993) * MapEntry: API Reference. (line 1526) * Memdev: API Reference. (line 12187) * MemoryDeviceInfo: API Reference. (line 13999) * MemoryInfo: API Reference. (line 13660) * MigrateSetParameters: API Reference. (line 10210) * MigrationCapability: API Reference. (line 9991) * MigrationCapabilityStatus: API Reference. (line 10066) * MigrationInfo: API Reference. (line 9811) * MigrationParameter: API Reference. (line 10113) * MigrationParameters: API Reference. (line 10309) * MigrationStats: API Reference. (line 9697) * MigrationStatus: API Reference. (line 9774) * MirrorCopyMode: API Reference. (line 2335) * MirrorSyncMode: API Reference. (line 2318) * MouseInfo: API Reference. (line 8960) * NameInfo: API Reference. (line 12848) * NbdServerRemoveMode: API Reference. (line 6443) * NetClientDriver: API Reference. (line 7590) * Netdev: API Reference. (line 7622) * NetdevBridgeOptions: API Reference. (line 7533) * NetdevHubPortOptions: API Reference. (line 7545) * NetdevL2TPv3Options: API Reference. (line 7478) * NetdevNetmapOptions: API Reference. (line 7558) * NetdevSocketOptions: API Reference. (line 7457) * NetdevTapOptions: API Reference. (line 7417) * NetdevUserOptions: API Reference. (line 7355) * NetdevVdeOptions: API Reference. (line 7517) * NetdevVhostUserOptions: API Reference. (line 7575) * NetFilterDirection: API Reference. (line 7707) * NetLegacy: API Reference. (line 7646) * NetLegacyNicOptions: API Reference. (line 7337) * NetLegacyOptions: API Reference. (line 7688) * NetLegacyOptionsType: API Reference. (line 7662) * NetworkAddressFamily: API Reference. (line 322) * NewImageMode: API Reference. (line 2442) * NFSServer: API Reference. (line 4706) * NFSTransport: API Reference. (line 4696) * NumaCpuOptions: API Reference. (line 12157) * NumaDistOptions: API Reference. (line 12090) * NumaNodeOptions: API Reference. (line 12070) * NumaOptions: API Reference. (line 12057) * NumaOptionsType: API Reference. (line 12045) * ObjectPropertyInfo: API Reference. (line 11402) * ObjectTypeInfo: API Reference. (line 11521) * OffAutoPCIBAR: API Reference. (line 177) * OnOffAuto: API Reference. (line 125) * OnOffSplit: API Reference. (line 139) * PCDIMMDeviceInfo: API Reference. (line 13958) * PciBridgeInfo: API Reference. (line 13107) * PciBusInfo: API Reference. (line 13085) * PciDeviceClass: API Reference. (line 13119) * PciDeviceId: API Reference. (line 13131) * PciDeviceInfo: API Reference. (line 13147) * PCIELinkSpeed: API Reference. (line 201) * PCIELinkWidth: API Reference. (line 217) * PciInfo: API Reference. (line 13176) * PciMemoryRange: API Reference. (line 13052) * PciMemoryRegion: API Reference. (line 13064) * PreallocMode: API Reference. (line 6059) * PRManagerInfo: API Reference. (line 6278) * QapiErrorClass: API Reference. (line 93) * QAuthZListFormat: API Reference. (line 9657) * QAuthZListPolicy: API Reference. (line 9645) * QAuthZListRule: API Reference. (line 9669) * QAuthZListRuleListHack: API Reference. (line 9683) * Qcow2BitmapInfo: API Reference. (line 1779) * Qcow2BitmapInfoFlags: API Reference. (line 1762) * Qcow2OverlapCheckFlags: API Reference. (line 4049) * Qcow2OverlapCheckMode: API Reference. (line 4031) * Qcow2OverlapChecks: API Reference. (line 4081) * QCryptoBlockCreateOptions: API Reference. (line 1041) * QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS: API Reference. (line 1003) * QCryptoBlockFormat: API Reference. (line 958) * QCryptoBlockInfo: API Reference. (line 1106) * QCryptoBlockInfoBase: API Reference. (line 1053) * QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS: API Reference. (line 1080) * QCryptoBlockInfoLUKSSlot: API Reference. (line 1064) * QCryptoBlockOpenOptions: API Reference. (line 1029) * QCryptoBlockOptionsBase: API Reference. (line 971) * QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS: API Reference. (line 992) * QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow: API Reference. (line 981) * QCryptoCipherAlgorithm: API Reference. (line 892) * QCryptoCipherMode: API Reference. (line 924) * QCryptoHashAlgorithm: API Reference. (line 870) * QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm: API Reference. (line 940) * QCryptoSecretFormat: API Reference. (line 857) * QCryptoTLSCredsEndpoint: API Reference. (line 843) * QKeyCode: API Reference. (line 9002) * QMPCapability: API Reference. (line 12701) * QuorumOpType: API Reference. (line 6534) * QuorumReadPattern: API Reference. (line 4504) * RbdAuthMode: API Reference. (line 4611) * ReplayMode: API Reference. (line 14111) * ReplicationMode: API Reference. (line 4665) * ReplicationStatus: API Reference. (line 10809) * RockerOfDpaFlow: API Reference. (line 8082) * RockerOfDpaFlowAction: API Reference. (line 8059) * RockerOfDpaFlowKey: API Reference. (line 8001) * RockerOfDpaFlowMask: API Reference. (line 8034) * RockerOfDpaGroup: API Reference. (line 8127) * RockerPort: API Reference. (line 7961) * RockerPortAutoneg: API Reference. (line 7949) * RockerPortDuplex: API Reference. (line 7937) * RockerSwitch: API Reference. (line 7907) * RunState: API Reference. (line 455) * RxFilterInfo: API Reference. (line 7739) * RxState: API Reference. (line 7725) * S390CrashReason: API Reference. (line 804) * SchemaInfo: API Reference. (line 11210) * SchemaInfoAlternate: API Reference. (line 11346) * SchemaInfoAlternateMember: API Reference. (line 11359) * SchemaInfoArray: API Reference. (line 11280) * SchemaInfoBuiltin: API Reference. (line 11233) * SchemaInfoCommand: API Reference. (line 11369) * SchemaInfoEnum: API Reference. (line 11269) * SchemaInfoEvent: API Reference. (line 11388) * SchemaInfoObject: API Reference. (line 11291) * SchemaInfoObjectMember: API Reference. (line 11314) * SchemaInfoObjectVariant: API Reference. (line 11333) * SchemaMetaType: API Reference. (line 11187) * SevCapability: API Reference. (line 14290) * SevInfo: API Reference. (line 14224) * SevLaunchMeasureInfo: API Reference. (line 14264) * SevState: API Reference. (line 14200) * SheepdogRedundancy: API Reference. (line 5444) * SheepdogRedundancyErasureCoded: API Reference. (line 5431) * SheepdogRedundancyFull: API Reference. (line 5421) * SheepdogRedundancyType: API Reference. (line 5408) * ShutdownCause: API Reference. (line 506) * SnapshotInfo: API Reference. (line 1361) * SocketAddress: API Reference. (line 437) * SocketAddressLegacy: API Reference. (line 396) * SocketAddressType: API Reference. (line 417) * SpiceBasicInfo: API Reference. (line 8409) * SpiceChannel: API Reference. (line 8438) * SpiceInfo: API Reference. (line 8480) * SpiceQueryMouseMode: API Reference. (line 8461) * SpiceServerInfo: API Reference. (line 8425) * SshHostKeyCheck: API Reference. (line 4237) * SshHostKeyCheckHashType: API Reference. (line 4211) * SshHostKeyCheckMode: API Reference. (line 4195) * SshHostKeyHash: API Reference. (line 4224) * StatusInfo: API Reference. (line 536) * String: API Reference. (line 153) * StrOrNull: API Reference. (line 163) * SysEmuTarget: API Reference. (line 239) * TargetInfo: API Reference. (line 13813) * ThrottleLimits: API Reference. (line 3452) * TPMEmulatorOptions: API Reference. (line 8260) * TPMInfo: API Reference. (line 8285) * TpmModel: API Reference. (line 8199) * TPMPassthroughOptions: API Reference. (line 8247) * TpmType: API Reference. (line 8223) * TpmTypeOptions: API Reference. (line 8270) * TraceEventInfo: API Reference. (line 11076) * TraceEventState: API Reference. (line 11062) * TransactionAction: API Reference. (line 10938) * TransactionProperties: API Reference. (line 10977) * UnixSocketAddress: API Reference. (line 371) * UuidInfo: API Reference. (line 12894) * VersionInfo: API Reference. (line 12728) * VersionTriple: API Reference. (line 12714) * VirtioPMEMDeviceInfo: API Reference. (line 13983) * VncBasicInfo: API Reference. (line 8640) * VncClientInfo: API Reference. (line 8674) * VncInfo: API Reference. (line 8691) * VncInfo2: API Reference. (line 8802) * VncPrimaryAuth: API Reference. (line 8730) * VncServerInfo: API Reference. (line 8660) * VncServerInfo2: API Reference. (line 8786) * VncVencryptSubAuth: API Reference. (line 8758) * VsockSocketAddress: API Reference. (line 381) * WatchdogAction: API Reference. (line 699) * X86CPUFeatureWordInfo: API Reference. (line 12130) * X86CPURegister32: API Reference. (line 12106) * XBZRLECacheStats: API Reference. (line 9735) * XDbgBlockGraph: API Reference. (line 2943) * XDbgBlockGraphEdge: API Reference. (line 2924) * XDbgBlockGraphNode: API Reference. (line 2876) * XDbgBlockGraphNodeType: API Reference. (line 2864)